]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git/blame - gdb/doc/gdb.texinfo
2003-01-15 Elena Zannoni <ezannoni@redhat.com>
[thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
CommitLineData
c906108c 1\input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
b6ba6518 2@c Copyright 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
1e698235 3@c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003
c906108c
SS
4@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5@c
5d161b24 6@c %**start of header
c906108c
SS
7@c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8@c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9@setfilename gdb.info
10@c
11@include gdb-cfg.texi
12@c
c906108c 13@settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
14@setchapternewpage odd
15@c %**end of header
16
17@iftex
18@c @smallbook
19@c @cropmarks
20@end iftex
21
22@finalout
23@syncodeindex ky cp
24
41afff9a 25@c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
48e934c6 26@c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
c906108c 27@syncodeindex vr cp
41afff9a 28@syncodeindex fn cp
c906108c
SS
29
30@c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
e9c75b65 31@set EDITION Ninth
c906108c
SS
32
33@c !!set GDB manual's revision date
87885426
FN
34@set DATE June 2002
35
36@c !!set GDB edit command default editor
37@set EDITOR /bin/ex
c906108c 38
6c0e9fb3 39@c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
c906108c 40
c906108c 41@c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
6d2ebf8b 42@c manuals to an info tree.
96a2c332
SS
43@dircategory Programming & development tools.
44@direntry
c906108c 45* Gdb: (gdb). The @sc{gnu} debugger.
96a2c332
SS
46@end direntry
47
c906108c
SS
48@ifinfo
49This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
50
51
5d161b24 52This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE},
c906108c
SS
53of @cite{Debugging with @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger}
54for @value{GDBN} Version @value{GDBVN}.
55
8a037dd7 56Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,@*
1e698235 57 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
c906108c 58
e9c75b65
EZ
59Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
60under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
61any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
959acfd1
EZ
62Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
63Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
64and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
c906108c 65
6826cf00
EZ
66(a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
67freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
68published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
69development.''
c906108c
SS
70@end ifinfo
71
72@titlepage
73@title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
74@subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
c906108c 75@sp 1
c906108c
SS
76@subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
77@subtitle @value{DATE}
9e9c5ae7 78@author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
c906108c 79@page
c906108c
SS
80@tex
81{\parskip=0pt
53a5351d 82\hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
c906108c
SS
83\hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
84\hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
85}
86@end tex
53a5351d 87
c906108c 88@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
8a037dd7 89Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
1e698235 901996, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
c906108c 91@sp 2
c906108c
SS
92Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
9359 Temple Place - Suite 330, @*
94Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA @*
6d2ebf8b 95ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
e9c75b65
EZ
96
97Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
98under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
99any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
959acfd1
EZ
100Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
101Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
102and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
e9c75b65 103
6826cf00
EZ
104(a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
105freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
106published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
107development.''
c906108c
SS
108@end titlepage
109@page
110
6c0e9fb3 111@ifnottex
6d2ebf8b
SS
112@node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
113
c906108c
SS
114@top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
115
116This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
117
5d161b24 118This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE}, for @value{GDBN} Version
c906108c
SS
119@value{GDBVN}.
120
1e698235 121Copyright (C) 1988-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6d2ebf8b
SS
122
123@menu
124* Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
125* Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
126
127* Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
128* Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
129* Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
130* Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
131* Stack:: Examining the stack
132* Source:: Examining source files
133* Data:: Examining data
e2e0bcd1 134* Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
b37052ae 135* Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
df0cd8c5 136* Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
6d2ebf8b
SS
137
138* Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
139
140* Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
141* Altering:: Altering execution
142* GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
143* Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
6b2f586d 144* Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
6d2ebf8b
SS
145* Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
146* Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
147* Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
c4555f82 148* TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
6d2ebf8b
SS
149* Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
150* Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
7162c0ca 151* GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
6d2ebf8b
SS
152
153* GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
154* Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
155
156* Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
157* Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
158* Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
eb12ee30 159* Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
e0ce93ac 160* Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
aab4e0ec
AC
161* Copying:: GNU General Public License says
162 how you can copy and share GDB
6826cf00 163* GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
6d2ebf8b
SS
164* Index:: Index
165@end menu
166
6c0e9fb3 167@end ifnottex
c906108c 168
449f3b6c 169@contents
449f3b6c 170
6d2ebf8b 171@node Summary
c906108c
SS
172@unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
173
174The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
175going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
176program was doing at the moment it crashed.
177
178@value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
179these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
180
181@itemize @bullet
182@item
183Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
184
185@item
186Make your program stop on specified conditions.
187
188@item
189Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
190
191@item
192Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
193effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
194@end itemize
195
cce74817 196You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C++.
c906108c 197For more information, see @ref{Support,,Supported languages}.
c906108c
SS
198For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
199
cce74817 200@cindex Modula-2
e632838e
AC
201Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
202@ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
c906108c 203
cce74817
JM
204@cindex Pascal
205Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
206nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
207entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
208syntax.
c906108c 209
c906108c
SS
210@cindex Fortran
211@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
53a5351d 212it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
cce74817 213underscore.
c906108c 214
c906108c
SS
215@menu
216* Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
217* Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
218@end menu
219
6d2ebf8b 220@node Free Software
c906108c
SS
221@unnumberedsec Free software
222
5d161b24 223@value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
c906108c
SS
224General Public License
225(GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
226program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
227freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
228the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
229Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
230Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
231
232Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
233you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
234from anyone else.
235
2666264b 236@unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
959acfd1
EZ
237
238The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
239the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
240include with the free software. Many of our most important
241programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
242texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
243when an important free software package does not come with a free
244manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
245gaps today.
246
247Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
248normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
249authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
250copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
251them from the free software world.
252
253That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
254from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
255manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
256only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
257contract to make it non-free.
258
259Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
260price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
261charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
262Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
263problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
264are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
265modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
266
267The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
268free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
269commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
270accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
271
272Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
273When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
274are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
275provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
276manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
277a changed version of the program is not really available to our
278community.
279
280Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
281acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
282author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
283authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
284to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
285may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
286with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
287are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
288of the manual.
289
290However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
291content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
292media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
293obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
294manual to replace it.
295
296Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
297lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
298free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
299the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
300realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
301the free software community.
302
303If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
304the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
305license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
306don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
307will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
308option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
309what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
310try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
42584a72 311is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
959acfd1
EZ
312
313You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
314manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
315copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
316improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
317at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
318and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
72c9928d
EZ
319Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
320have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
959acfd1
EZ
321
322The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
323published by other publishers, at
324@url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
325
6d2ebf8b 326@node Contributors
96a2c332
SS
327@unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
328
329Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
330other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
331development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
332of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
333to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
334file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
c906108c
SS
335blow-by-blow account.
336
337Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
338
339@quotation
340@emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
341or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
342omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
343@end quotation
344
345So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
346particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
347releases:
299ffc64 348Andrew Cagney (releases 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
c906108c
SS
349Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
350Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
351Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
352Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
353Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
354John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
355Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
356and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
357
358Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
359Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
360
b37052ae
EZ
361Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
362in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
363Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
364demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
365much general update work leading to release 3.0).
c906108c 366
b37052ae 367@value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
c906108c
SS
368object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
369Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
370
371David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
372the original support for encapsulated COFF.
373
96c405b3 374Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF2 support.
c906108c
SS
375
376Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
377Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
378support.
379Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
380Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
381Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
382David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
383Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
384Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
385Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
386Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
387Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
388Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
389Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
390Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
391Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
392Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
393Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
a37295f9 394Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
c906108c 395
1104b9e7 396Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
c906108c
SS
397
398Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
399libraries.
400
401Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
402about several machine instruction sets.
403
404Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
405remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
406contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
407and RDI targets, respectively.
408
409Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
410command-line editing and command history.
411
7a292a7a
SS
412Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
413Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
c906108c 414
5d161b24 415Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
b37052ae 416He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
c906108c 417symbols.
c906108c
SS
418
419Hitachi America, Ltd. sponsored the support for H8/300, H8/500, and
420Super-H processors.
421
422NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
423
424Mitsubishi sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D processors.
425
426Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
427
428Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
429
96a2c332 430Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
c906108c
SS
431
432Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
433watchpoints.
434
435Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
436
437Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
438
439Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
96a2c332 440nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
441
442The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
443support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
b37052ae 444(narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
c906108c
SS
445compiler, and the terminal user interface: Ben Krepp, Richard Title,
446John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann, Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve
447Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase provided HP-specific
448information in this manual.
449
b37052ae
EZ
450DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
451Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
452
96a2c332
SS
453Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
454development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
2df3850c
JM
455fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
456Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
457Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
458Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
459Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
460addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
461JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
462Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
463Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
464Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
465Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
466Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
467Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
c906108c 468
e2e0bcd1
JB
469Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
470Hat.
c906108c 471
6d2ebf8b 472@node Sample Session
c906108c
SS
473@chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
474
475You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
476However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
477debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
478
479@iftex
480In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
481to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
482@end iftex
483
484@c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
485@c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
486
487One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
488processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
489quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
490definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
491session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
492then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
493same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
494@code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
495procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
496
497@smallexample
498$ @b{cd gnu/m4}
499$ @b{./m4}
500@b{define(foo,0000)}
501
502@b{foo}
5030000
504@b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
505
506@b{bar}
5070000
508@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
509
510@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
511@b{baz}
512@b{C-d}
513m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
514@end smallexample
515
516@noindent
517Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
518
c906108c
SS
519@smallexample
520$ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
521@c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
522@c FIXME... format to come out better.
523@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
5d161b24 524 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
c906108c 525 the conditions.
5d161b24 526There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
c906108c
SS
527 for details.
528
529@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
530(@value{GDBP})
531@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
532
533@noindent
534@value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
535rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
536We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
537that examples fit in this manual.
538
539@smallexample
540(@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
541@end smallexample
542
543@noindent
544We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
545Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
546@code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
547@code{break} command.
548
549@smallexample
550(@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
551Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
552@end smallexample
553
554@noindent
555Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
556control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
557subroutine, the program runs as usual:
558
559@smallexample
560(@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
561Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
562@b{define(foo,0000)}
563
564@b{foo}
5650000
566@end smallexample
567
568@noindent
569To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
570suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
571context where it stops.
572
573@smallexample
574@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
575
5d161b24 576Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
c906108c
SS
577 at builtin.c:879
578879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
579@end smallexample
580
581@noindent
582Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
583the next line of the current function.
584
585@smallexample
586(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
587882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
588 : nil,
589@end smallexample
590
591@noindent
592@code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
593by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
594@code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
595subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
596
597@smallexample
598(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
599set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
600 at input.c:530
601530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
602@end smallexample
603
604@noindent
605The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
606suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
607shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
608command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
609in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
610stack frame for each active subroutine.
611
612@smallexample
613(@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
614#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
615 at input.c:530
5d161b24 616#1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
c906108c
SS
617 at builtin.c:882
618#2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
619#3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
620 at macro.c:71
621#4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
622#5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
623@end smallexample
624
625@noindent
626We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
627times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
628falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
629
630@smallexample
631(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
6320x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
633(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
6340x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
635def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
636(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
637536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
638 : xstrdup(rq);
639(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
640538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
641@end smallexample
642
643@noindent
644The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
645@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
646and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
647(@code{print}) to see their values.
648
649@smallexample
650(@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
651$1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
652(@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
653$2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
654@end smallexample
655
656@noindent
657@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
658To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
659surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
660
661@smallexample
662(@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
663533 xfree(rquote);
664534
665535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
666 : xstrdup (lq);
667536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
668 : xstrdup (rq);
669537
670538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
671539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
672540 @}
673541
674542 void
675@end smallexample
676
677@noindent
678Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
679@code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
680
681@smallexample
682(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
683539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
684(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
685540 @}
686(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
687$3 = 9
688(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
689$4 = 7
690@end smallexample
691
692@noindent
693That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
694@code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
695@code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
696the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
697any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
698assignments.
699
700@smallexample
701(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
702$5 = 7
703(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
704$6 = 9
705@end smallexample
706
707@noindent
708Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
709@code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
710executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
711example that caused trouble initially:
712
713@smallexample
714(@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
715Continuing.
716
717@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
718
719baz
7200000
721@end smallexample
722
723@noindent
724Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
725problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
726lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
727
728@smallexample
729@b{C-d}
730Program exited normally.
731@end smallexample
732
733@noindent
734The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
735indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
736session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
737
738@smallexample
739(@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
740@end smallexample
c906108c 741
6d2ebf8b 742@node Invocation
c906108c
SS
743@chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
744
745This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
5d161b24 746The essentials are:
c906108c 747@itemize @bullet
5d161b24 748@item
53a5351d 749type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
5d161b24 750@item
c906108c
SS
751type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{C-d} to exit.
752@end itemize
753
754@menu
755* Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
756* Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
757* Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
758@end menu
759
6d2ebf8b 760@node Invoking GDB
c906108c
SS
761@section Invoking @value{GDBN}
762
c906108c
SS
763Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
764@value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
765
766You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
767to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
768
c906108c
SS
769The command-line options described here are designed
770to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
5d161b24 771options may effectively be unavailable.
c906108c
SS
772
773The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
774specifying an executable program:
775
474c8240 776@smallexample
c906108c 777@value{GDBP} @var{program}
474c8240 778@end smallexample
c906108c 779
c906108c
SS
780@noindent
781You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
782specified:
783
474c8240 784@smallexample
c906108c 785@value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
474c8240 786@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
787
788You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
789to debug a running process:
790
474c8240 791@smallexample
c906108c 792@value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
474c8240 793@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
794
795@noindent
796would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
797named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
798
c906108c 799Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
2df3850c
JM
800complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
801debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
802``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
803will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
c906108c 804
aa26fa3a
TT
805You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
806executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
807option processing.
474c8240 808@smallexample
aa26fa3a 809gdb --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
474c8240 810@end smallexample
aa26fa3a
TT
811This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
812@code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
813
96a2c332 814You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
c906108c
SS
815@value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
816
817@smallexample
818@value{GDBP} -silent
819@end smallexample
820
821@noindent
822You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
823options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
824
825@noindent
826Type
827
474c8240 828@smallexample
c906108c 829@value{GDBP} -help
474c8240 830@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
831
832@noindent
833to display all available options and briefly describe their use
834(@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
835
836All options and command line arguments you give are processed
837in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
838@samp{-x} option is used.
839
840
841@menu
c906108c
SS
842* File Options:: Choosing files
843* Mode Options:: Choosing modes
844@end menu
845
6d2ebf8b 846@node File Options
c906108c
SS
847@subsection Choosing files
848
2df3850c 849When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
c906108c
SS
850specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
851the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
19837790
MS
852@samp{-c} (or @samp{-p} options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
853first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
854equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
855second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
856equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
857If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
858first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
859to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
860a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
79f12247 861prefixing it with @file{./}, eg. @file{./12345}.
7a292a7a
SS
862
863If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
864such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
865argument and ignore it.
c906108c
SS
866
867Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
868following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
869them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
870(If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
871than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
872
d700128c
EZ
873@c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
874@c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
875@c it.
876
c906108c
SS
877@table @code
878@item -symbols @var{file}
879@itemx -s @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
880@cindex @code{--symbols}
881@cindex @code{-s}
c906108c
SS
882Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
883
884@item -exec @var{file}
885@itemx -e @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
886@cindex @code{--exec}
887@cindex @code{-e}
7a292a7a
SS
888Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
889and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
c906108c
SS
890
891@item -se @var{file}
d700128c 892@cindex @code{--se}
c906108c
SS
893Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
894file.
895
c906108c
SS
896@item -core @var{file}
897@itemx -c @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
898@cindex @code{--core}
899@cindex @code{-c}
19837790 900Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
c906108c
SS
901
902@item -c @var{number}
19837790
MS
903@item -pid @var{number}
904@itemx -p @var{number}
905@cindex @code{--pid}
906@cindex @code{-p}
907Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
908If there is no such process, @value{GDBN} will attempt to open a core
909file named @var{number}.
c906108c
SS
910
911@item -command @var{file}
912@itemx -x @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
913@cindex @code{--command}
914@cindex @code{-x}
c906108c
SS
915Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
916Files,, Command files}.
917
918@item -directory @var{directory}
919@itemx -d @var{directory}
d700128c
EZ
920@cindex @code{--directory}
921@cindex @code{-d}
c906108c
SS
922Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
923
c906108c
SS
924@item -m
925@itemx -mapped
d700128c
EZ
926@cindex @code{--mapped}
927@cindex @code{-m}
c906108c
SS
928@emph{Warning: this option depends on operating system facilities that are not
929supported on all systems.}@*
930If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the @code{mmap}
5d161b24 931system call, you can use this option
c906108c
SS
932to have @value{GDBN} write the symbols from your
933program into a reusable file in the current directory. If the program you are debugging is
96a2c332 934called @file{/tmp/fred}, the mapped symbol file is @file{/tmp/fred.syms}.
c906108c
SS
935Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions notice the presence of this file,
936and can quickly map in symbol information from it, rather than reading
937the symbol table from the executable program.
938
939The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where @value{GDBN}
940is run. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN} symbol
941table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c 942
c906108c
SS
943@item -r
944@itemx -readnow
d700128c
EZ
945@cindex @code{--readnow}
946@cindex @code{-r}
c906108c
SS
947Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
948the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
949This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
53a5351d 950
c906108c
SS
951@end table
952
2df3850c 953You typically combine the @code{-mapped} and @code{-readnow} options in
c906108c 954order to build a @file{.syms} file that contains complete symbol
2df3850c
JM
955information. (@xref{Files,,Commands to specify files}, for information
956on @file{.syms} files.) A simple @value{GDBN} invocation to do nothing
957but build a @file{.syms} file for future use is:
c906108c 958
474c8240 959@smallexample
2df3850c 960gdb -batch -nx -mapped -readnow programname
474c8240 961@end smallexample
c906108c 962
6d2ebf8b 963@node Mode Options
c906108c
SS
964@subsection Choosing modes
965
966You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
967batch mode or quiet mode.
968
969@table @code
970@item -nx
971@itemx -n
d700128c
EZ
972@cindex @code{--nx}
973@cindex @code{-n}
96565e91 974Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
2df3850c
JM
975@value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
976options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
977files}.
c906108c
SS
978
979@item -quiet
d700128c 980@itemx -silent
c906108c 981@itemx -q
d700128c
EZ
982@cindex @code{--quiet}
983@cindex @code{--silent}
984@cindex @code{-q}
c906108c
SS
985``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
986messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
987
988@item -batch
d700128c 989@cindex @code{--batch}
c906108c
SS
990Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
991command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
992initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
993nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
994in the command files.
995
2df3850c
JM
996Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
997example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
998make this more useful, the message
c906108c 999
474c8240 1000@smallexample
c906108c 1001Program exited normally.
474c8240 1002@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1003
1004@noindent
2df3850c
JM
1005(which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1006@value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1007mode.
1008
1009@item -nowindows
1010@itemx -nw
d700128c
EZ
1011@cindex @code{--nowindows}
1012@cindex @code{-nw}
2df3850c 1013``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
96a2c332 1014(GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
2df3850c
JM
1015interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1016
1017@item -windows
1018@itemx -w
d700128c
EZ
1019@cindex @code{--windows}
1020@cindex @code{-w}
2df3850c
JM
1021If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1022used if possible.
c906108c
SS
1023
1024@item -cd @var{directory}
d700128c 1025@cindex @code{--cd}
c906108c
SS
1026Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1027instead of the current directory.
1028
c906108c
SS
1029@item -fullname
1030@itemx -f
d700128c
EZ
1031@cindex @code{--fullname}
1032@cindex @code{-f}
7a292a7a
SS
1033@sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1034subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1035number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1036displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1037recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1038the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1039and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1040@samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1041frame.
c906108c 1042
d700128c
EZ
1043@item -epoch
1044@cindex @code{--epoch}
1045The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1046@value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1047routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1048separate window.
1049
1050@item -annotate @var{level}
1051@cindex @code{--annotate}
1052This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1053effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1054(@pxref{Annotations}).
1055Annotation level controls how much information does @value{GDBN} print
1056together with its prompt, values of expressions, source lines, and other
1057types of output. Level 0 is the normal, level 1 is for use when
1058@value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 2 is the
1059maximum annotation suitable for programs that control @value{GDBN}.
1060
1061@item -async
1062@cindex @code{--async}
1063Use the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1064@value{GDBN} processes all events, such as user keyboard input, via a
1065special event loop. This allows @value{GDBN} to accept and process user
1066commands in parallel with the debugged process being
1067run@footnote{@value{GDBN} built with @sc{djgpp} tools for
1068MS-DOS/MS-Windows supports this mode of operation, but the event loop is
1069suspended when the debuggee runs.}, so you don't need to wait for
1070control to return to @value{GDBN} before you type the next command.
b37052ae 1071(@emph{Note:} as of version 5.1, the target side of the asynchronous
d700128c
EZ
1072operation is not yet in place, so @samp{-async} does not work fully
1073yet.)
1074@c FIXME: when the target side of the event loop is done, the above NOTE
1075@c should be removed.
1076
1077When the standard input is connected to a terminal device, @value{GDBN}
1078uses the asynchronous event loop by default, unless disabled by the
1079@samp{-noasync} option.
1080
1081@item -noasync
1082@cindex @code{--noasync}
1083Disable the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1084
aa26fa3a
TT
1085@item --args
1086@cindex @code{--args}
1087Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1088executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1089This option stops option processing.
1090
2df3850c
JM
1091@item -baud @var{bps}
1092@itemx -b @var{bps}
d700128c
EZ
1093@cindex @code{--baud}
1094@cindex @code{-b}
c906108c
SS
1095Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1096interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
c906108c
SS
1097
1098@item -tty @var{device}
d700128c
EZ
1099@itemx -t @var{device}
1100@cindex @code{--tty}
1101@cindex @code{-t}
c906108c
SS
1102Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1103@c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
c906108c 1104
53a5351d 1105@c resolve the situation of these eventually
c4555f82
SC
1106@item -tui
1107@cindex @code{--tui}
1108Activate the Terminal User Interface when starting.
1109The Terminal User Interface manages several text windows on the terminal,
1110showing source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1111(@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}).
1112Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs
1113(@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
53a5351d
JM
1114
1115@c @item -xdb
d700128c 1116@c @cindex @code{--xdb}
53a5351d
JM
1117@c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1118@c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1119@c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1120@c systems.
1121
d700128c
EZ
1122@item -interpreter @var{interp}
1123@cindex @code{--interpreter}
1124Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1125program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
94bbb2c0
AC
1126communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1127
da0f9dcd
AC
1128@samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1129@value{GDBN} to use the current @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface}
1130(@pxref{GDB/MI, , The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}). The previous @sc{gdb/mi}
1131interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3, can be selected with
1132@samp{--interpreter=mi1}. Earlier @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces
1133are not supported.
d700128c
EZ
1134
1135@item -write
1136@cindex @code{--write}
1137Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1138is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1139(@pxref{Patching}).
1140
1141@item -statistics
1142@cindex @code{--statistics}
1143This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1144memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1145
1146@item -version
1147@cindex @code{--version}
1148This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1149no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1150
c906108c
SS
1151@end table
1152
6d2ebf8b 1153@node Quitting GDB
c906108c
SS
1154@section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1155@cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1156@cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1157
1158@table @code
1159@kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
41afff9a 1160@kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
96a2c332
SS
1161@item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1162@itemx q
1163To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1164@code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{C-d}). If you
1165do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1166otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1167error code.
c906108c
SS
1168@end table
1169
1170@cindex interrupt
1171An interrupt (often @kbd{C-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1172terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1173returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1174character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1175until a time when it is safe.
1176
c906108c
SS
1177If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1178device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1179(@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running process}).
c906108c 1180
6d2ebf8b 1181@node Shell Commands
c906108c
SS
1182@section Shell commands
1183
1184If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1185debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1186just use the @code{shell} command.
1187
1188@table @code
1189@kindex shell
1190@cindex shell escape
1191@item shell @var{command string}
1192Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
c906108c 1193If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
d4f3574e
SS
1194shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1195(@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
c906108c
SS
1196@end table
1197
1198The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1199You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1200@value{GDBN}:
1201
1202@table @code
1203@kindex make
1204@cindex calling make
1205@item make @var{make-args}
1206Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1207arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1208@end table
1209
6d2ebf8b 1210@node Commands
c906108c
SS
1211@chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1212
1213You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1214name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1215@value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1216key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1217show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1218
1219@menu
1220* Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1221* Completion:: Command completion
1222* Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1223@end menu
1224
6d2ebf8b 1225@node Command Syntax
c906108c
SS
1226@section Command syntax
1227
1228A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1229how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1230arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1231command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1232step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
96a2c332 1233with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
c906108c
SS
1234
1235@cindex abbreviation
1236@value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1237unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1238documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1239abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1240equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1241names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1242arguments to the @code{help} command.
1243
1244@cindex repeating commands
41afff9a 1245@kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
c906108c 1246A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
96a2c332 1247repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
c906108c
SS
1248will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1249repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1250repeat.
1251
1252The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1253@key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1254exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1255
1256@value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1257output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1258(@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen size}). Since it is easy to press one
1259@key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1260repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1261
41afff9a 1262@kindex # @r{(a comment)}
c906108c
SS
1263@cindex comment
1264Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1265nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1266Files,,Command files}).
1267
88118b3a
TT
1268@cindex repeating command sequences
1269@kindex C-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1270The @kbd{C-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1271commands. This command accepts the current line, like @kbd{RET}, and
1272then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1273for editing.
1274
6d2ebf8b 1275@node Completion
c906108c
SS
1276@section Command completion
1277
1278@cindex completion
1279@cindex word completion
1280@value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1281only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1282are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1283commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1284
1285Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1286of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1287word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1288enter it). For example, if you type
1289
1290@c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1291@c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1292@c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1293@c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
474c8240 1294@smallexample
c906108c 1295(@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
474c8240 1296@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1297
1298@noindent
1299@value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1300the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1301
474c8240 1302@smallexample
c906108c 1303(@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
474c8240 1304@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1305
1306@noindent
1307You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1308breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1309@samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1310were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1311might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1312to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1313
1314If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1315@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1316characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1317@value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1318example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1319begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1320just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1321function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1322example:
1323
474c8240 1324@smallexample
c906108c
SS
1325(@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1326@exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
5d161b24
DB
1327make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1328make_abs_section make_function_type
1329make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1330make_cleanup make_reference_type
c906108c
SS
1331make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1332(@value{GDBP}) b make_
474c8240 1333@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1334
1335@noindent
1336After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1337partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1338command.
1339
1340If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
b37052ae 1341can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
7a292a7a 1342means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
c906108c 1343key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
7a292a7a 1344one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
c906108c
SS
1345
1346@cindex quotes in commands
1347@cindex completion of quoted strings
1348Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
7a292a7a
SS
1349parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1350its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1351situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1352@value{GDBN} commands.
c906108c 1353
c906108c 1354The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
b37052ae
EZ
1355name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1356overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1357by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1358may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1359that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1360that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1361word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1362@code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1363@value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1364when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
c906108c 1365
474c8240 1366@smallexample
96a2c332 1367(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
c906108c
SS
1368bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1369(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
474c8240 1370@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1371
1372In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1373quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1374completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1375place:
1376
474c8240 1377@smallexample
c906108c
SS
1378(@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1379@exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1380(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
474c8240 1381@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1382
1383@noindent
1384In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1385you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1386completion on an overloaded symbol.
1387
d4f3574e 1388For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C plus plus
b37052ae 1389expressions, ,C@t{++} expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
c906108c 1390overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
b37052ae 1391see @ref{Debugging C plus plus, ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
c906108c
SS
1392
1393
6d2ebf8b 1394@node Help
c906108c
SS
1395@section Getting help
1396@cindex online documentation
1397@kindex help
1398
5d161b24 1399You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
c906108c
SS
1400using the command @code{help}.
1401
1402@table @code
41afff9a 1403@kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
c906108c
SS
1404@item help
1405@itemx h
1406You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1407display a short list of named classes of commands:
1408
1409@smallexample
1410(@value{GDBP}) help
1411List of classes of commands:
1412
2df3850c 1413aliases -- Aliases of other commands
c906108c 1414breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
2df3850c 1415data -- Examining data
c906108c 1416files -- Specifying and examining files
2df3850c
JM
1417internals -- Maintenance commands
1418obscure -- Obscure features
1419running -- Running the program
1420stack -- Examining the stack
c906108c
SS
1421status -- Status inquiries
1422support -- Support facilities
96a2c332
SS
1423tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without@*
1424 stopping the program
c906108c 1425user-defined -- User-defined commands
c906108c 1426
5d161b24 1427Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
c906108c 1428commands in that class.
5d161b24 1429Type "help" followed by command name for full
c906108c
SS
1430documentation.
1431Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1432(@value{GDBP})
1433@end smallexample
96a2c332 1434@c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
c906108c
SS
1435
1436@item help @var{class}
1437Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1438list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1439help display for the class @code{status}:
1440
1441@smallexample
1442(@value{GDBP}) help status
1443Status inquiries.
1444
1445List of commands:
1446
1447@c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1448@c to fit in smallbook page size.
2df3850c
JM
1449info -- Generic command for showing things
1450 about the program being debugged
1451show -- Generic command for showing things
1452 about the debugger
c906108c 1453
5d161b24 1454Type "help" followed by command name for full
c906108c
SS
1455documentation.
1456Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1457(@value{GDBP})
1458@end smallexample
1459
1460@item help @var{command}
1461With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1462short paragraph on how to use that command.
1463
6837a0a2
DB
1464@kindex apropos
1465@item apropos @var{args}
1466The @code{apropos @var{args}} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1467commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1468@var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1469
1470@smallexample
1471apropos reload
1472@end smallexample
1473
b37052ae
EZ
1474@noindent
1475results in:
6837a0a2
DB
1476
1477@smallexample
6d2ebf8b
SS
1478@c @group
1479set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1480 multiple times in one run
1481show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1482 multiple times in one run
1483@c @end group
6837a0a2
DB
1484@end smallexample
1485
c906108c
SS
1486@kindex complete
1487@item complete @var{args}
1488The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1489for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1490command you want completed. For example:
1491
1492@smallexample
1493complete i
1494@end smallexample
1495
1496@noindent results in:
1497
1498@smallexample
1499@group
2df3850c
JM
1500if
1501ignore
c906108c
SS
1502info
1503inspect
c906108c
SS
1504@end group
1505@end smallexample
1506
1507@noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1508@end table
1509
1510In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1511and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1512of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1513manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1514under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1515all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1516
1517@c @group
1518@table @code
1519@kindex info
41afff9a 1520@kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
c906108c
SS
1521@item info
1522This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1523program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1524with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1525registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1526You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1527@w{@code{help info}}.
1528
1529@kindex set
1530@item set
5d161b24 1531You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
c906108c
SS
1532@code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1533@code{set prompt $}.
1534
1535@kindex show
1536@item show
5d161b24 1537In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
c906108c
SS
1538@value{GDBN} itself.
1539You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1540related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1541system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1542which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1543
1544@kindex info set
1545To display all the settable parameters and their current
1546values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1547@code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1548@c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1549@c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1550@c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1551@end table
1552@c @end group
1553
1554Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1555exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1556
1557@table @code
1558@kindex show version
1559@cindex version number
1560@item show version
1561Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
2df3850c
JM
1562information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1563@value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1564version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1565commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1566system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
96a2c332 1567variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
2df3850c
JM
1568The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1569@value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
1570
1571@kindex show copying
1572@item show copying
1573Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1574
1575@kindex show warranty
1576@item show warranty
2df3850c 1577Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
96a2c332 1578if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
2df3850c 1579
c906108c
SS
1580@end table
1581
6d2ebf8b 1582@node Running
c906108c
SS
1583@chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1584
1585When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1586debugging information when you compile it.
7a292a7a
SS
1587
1588You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1589of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1590your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1591kill a child process.
c906108c
SS
1592
1593@menu
1594* Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1595* Starting:: Starting your program
c906108c
SS
1596* Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1597* Environment:: Your program's environment
c906108c
SS
1598
1599* Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1600* Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1601* Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1602* Kill Process:: Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1603
1604* Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1605* Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1606@end menu
1607
6d2ebf8b 1608@node Compilation
c906108c
SS
1609@section Compiling for debugging
1610
1611In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1612debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1613is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1614variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1615and addresses in the executable code.
1616
1617To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1618the compiler.
1619
e2e0bcd1
JB
1620Most compilers do not include information about preprocessor macros in
1621the debugging information if you specify the @option{-g} flag alone,
1622because this information is rather large. Version 3.1 of @value{NGCC},
1623the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you specify the
1624options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1625debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1626``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact ways
1627to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1628@option{-g} alone.
1629
c906108c
SS
1630Many C compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O}
1631options together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1632executables containing debugging information.
1633
53a5351d
JM
1634@value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1635without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1636recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1637program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1638in pushing your luck.
c906108c
SS
1639
1640@cindex optimized code, debugging
1641@cindex debugging optimized code
1642When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1643optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1644really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1645exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1646variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1647variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1648
1649Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1650@samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1651doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1652please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1653
1654Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1655@w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1656format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1657
1658@need 2000
6d2ebf8b 1659@node Starting
c906108c
SS
1660@section Starting your program
1661@cindex starting
1662@cindex running
1663
1664@table @code
1665@kindex run
41afff9a 1666@kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
c906108c
SS
1667@item run
1668@itemx r
7a292a7a
SS
1669Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1670You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1671argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1672@value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1673(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
c906108c
SS
1674
1675@end table
1676
c906108c
SS
1677If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1678supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1679that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1680@code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1681
1682The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1683receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1684information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1685can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1686your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1687divided into four categories:
1688
1689@table @asis
1690@item The @emph{arguments.}
1691Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1692@code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1693is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1694(such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1695the arguments.
1696In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1697@code{SHELL} environment variable.
1698@xref{Arguments, ,Your program's arguments}.
1699
1700@item The @emph{environment.}
1701Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1702use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1703environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1704your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}.
1705
1706@item The @emph{working directory.}
1707Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1708the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1709@xref{Working Directory, ,Your program's working directory}.
1710
1711@item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1712Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1713standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1714in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1715set a different device for your program.
1716@xref{Input/Output, ,Your program's input and output}.
1717
1718@cindex pipes
1719@emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1720pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1721program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1722wrong program.
1723@end table
c906108c
SS
1724
1725When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1726immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and continuing}, for discussion
1727of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1728stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1729or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1730
1731If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1732time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1733table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1734your current breakpoints.
1735
6d2ebf8b 1736@node Arguments
c906108c
SS
1737@section Your program's arguments
1738
1739@cindex arguments (to your program)
1740The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
5d161b24 1741@code{run} command.
c906108c
SS
1742They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1743performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1744@code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1745@value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
d4f3574e
SS
1746the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1747
1748On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1749@value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1750calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1751the program, not by the shell.
c906108c
SS
1752
1753@code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1754@code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1755
c906108c 1756@table @code
41afff9a 1757@kindex set args
c906108c
SS
1758@item set args
1759Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1760@code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1761with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1762using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1763it again without arguments.
1764
1765@kindex show args
1766@item show args
1767Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1768@end table
1769
6d2ebf8b 1770@node Environment
c906108c
SS
1771@section Your program's environment
1772
1773@cindex environment (of your program)
1774The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1775their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1776your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1777path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1778the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1779debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1780environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1781
1782@table @code
1783@kindex path
1784@item path @var{directory}
1785Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
17cc6a06
EZ
1786(the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
1787The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
d4f3574e
SS
1788You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1789system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1790MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1791is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
c906108c
SS
1792
1793You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1794working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1795use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1796@code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1797@var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1798@var{directory} to the search path.
1799@c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1800@c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1801
1802@kindex show paths
1803@item show paths
1804Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1805environment variable).
1806
1807@kindex show environment
1808@item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1809Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1810your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
1811print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1812your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1813
1814@kindex set environment
53a5351d 1815@item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
1816Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
1817changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
1818be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
1819any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
1820parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
1821null value.
1822@c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
1823@c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
1824
1825For example, this command:
1826
474c8240 1827@smallexample
c906108c 1828set env USER = foo
474c8240 1829@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1830
1831@noindent
d4f3574e 1832tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
c906108c
SS
1833@samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
1834are not actually required.)
1835
1836@kindex unset environment
1837@item unset environment @var{varname}
1838Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
1839program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
1840@code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
1841rather than assigning it an empty value.
1842@end table
1843
d4f3574e
SS
1844@emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
1845the shell indicated
c906108c
SS
1846by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
1847@code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
1848that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
1849@file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
1850your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
1851files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
1852@file{.profile}.
1853
6d2ebf8b 1854@node Working Directory
c906108c
SS
1855@section Your program's working directory
1856
1857@cindex working directory (of your program)
1858Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
1859working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
1860The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
1861from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
1862working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
1863
1864The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
1865that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1866specify files}.
1867
1868@table @code
1869@kindex cd
1870@item cd @var{directory}
1871Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
1872
1873@kindex pwd
1874@item pwd
1875Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
1876@end table
1877
6d2ebf8b 1878@node Input/Output
c906108c
SS
1879@section Your program's input and output
1880
1881@cindex redirection
1882@cindex i/o
1883@cindex terminal
1884By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
5d161b24 1885the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
c906108c
SS
1886to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
1887modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
1888running your program.
1889
1890@table @code
1891@kindex info terminal
1892@item info terminal
1893Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
1894program is using.
1895@end table
1896
1897You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
1898redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
1899
474c8240 1900@smallexample
c906108c 1901run > outfile
474c8240 1902@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1903
1904@noindent
1905starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
1906
1907@kindex tty
1908@cindex controlling terminal
1909Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
1910with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
1911argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
1912commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
1913process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
1914
474c8240 1915@smallexample
c906108c 1916tty /dev/ttyb
474c8240 1917@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1918
1919@noindent
1920directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
1921default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
1922that as their controlling terminal.
1923
1924An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
1925effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
1926terminal.
1927
1928When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
1929command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
1930for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal.
1931
6d2ebf8b 1932@node Attach
c906108c
SS
1933@section Debugging an already-running process
1934@kindex attach
1935@cindex attach
1936
1937@table @code
1938@item attach @var{process-id}
1939This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
1940outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
1941targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
1942find out the process-id of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
1943or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
1944
1945@code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
1946executing the command.
1947@end table
1948
1949To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
1950which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
1951programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
1952also have permission to send the process a signal.
1953
1954When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
1955the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
1956the program is not found) by using the source file search path
1957(@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying source directories}). You can also use
1958the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1959Specify Files}.
1960
1961The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
1962process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
53a5351d
JM
1963with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
1964you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
1965can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
1966process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
c906108c
SS
1967attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
1968
1969@table @code
1970@kindex detach
1971@item detach
1972When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
1973@code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
1974the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
1975that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
1976are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
1977@code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
1978executing the command.
1979@end table
1980
1981If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
1982attached process, you kill that process. By default, @value{GDBN} asks
1983for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
1984control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
1985confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
1986messages}).
1987
6d2ebf8b 1988@node Kill Process
c906108c 1989@section Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1990
1991@table @code
1992@kindex kill
1993@item kill
1994Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
1995@end table
1996
1997This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
1998running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
1999is running.
2000
2001On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2002while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2003@code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2004outside the debugger.
2005
2006The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2007relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2008executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2009next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2010reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2011breakpoint settings).
2012
6d2ebf8b 2013@node Threads
c906108c 2014@section Debugging programs with multiple threads
c906108c
SS
2015
2016@cindex threads of execution
2017@cindex multiple threads
2018@cindex switching threads
2019In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2020may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2021of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2022the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2023that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2024modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2025registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2026
2027@value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2028programs:
2029
2030@itemize @bullet
2031@item automatic notification of new threads
2032@item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2033@item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
5d161b24 2034@item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
c906108c
SS
2035a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2036@item thread-specific breakpoints
2037@end itemize
2038
c906108c
SS
2039@quotation
2040@emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2041@value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2042If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2043effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2044from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2045like this:
2046
2047@smallexample
2048(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2049(@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2050Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2051see the IDs of currently known threads.
2052@end smallexample
2053@c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2054@c doesn't support threads"?
2055@end quotation
c906108c
SS
2056
2057@cindex focus of debugging
2058@cindex current thread
2059The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2060threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2061control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2062This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2063program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2064
41afff9a 2065@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
c906108c
SS
2066@cindex thread identifier (system)
2067@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2068@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2069@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2070Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2071the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2072form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2073whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2074LynxOS, you might see
2075
474c8240 2076@smallexample
c906108c 2077[New process 35 thread 27]
474c8240 2078@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2079
2080@noindent
2081when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2082the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2083further qualifier.
2084
2085@c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2086@c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
6ca652b0 2087@c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
c906108c
SS
2088@c program?
2089@c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2090@c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
5d161b24 2091@c threads ab initio?
c906108c
SS
2092
2093@cindex thread number
2094@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2095For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2096number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2097
2098@table @code
2099@kindex info threads
2100@item info threads
2101Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2102program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2103
2104@enumerate
2105@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2106
2107@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2108
2109@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2110@end enumerate
2111
2112@noindent
2113An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2114indicates the current thread.
2115
5d161b24 2116For example,
c906108c
SS
2117@end table
2118@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2119
2120@smallexample
2121(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2122 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2123 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2124* 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2125 at threadtest.c:68
2126@end smallexample
53a5351d
JM
2127
2128On HP-UX systems:
c906108c
SS
2129
2130@cindex thread number
2131@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2132For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2133number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2134thread in your program.
2135
41afff9a
EZ
2136@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2137@cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
c906108c
SS
2138@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2139@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2140@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2141Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2142both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2143form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2144whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2145HP-UX, you see
2146
474c8240 2147@smallexample
c906108c 2148[New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
474c8240 2149@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2150
2151@noindent
5d161b24 2152when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
c906108c
SS
2153
2154@table @code
2155@kindex info threads
2156@item info threads
2157Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2158program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2159
2160@enumerate
2161@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2162
2163@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2164
2165@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2166@end enumerate
2167
2168@noindent
2169An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2170indicates the current thread.
2171
5d161b24 2172For example,
c906108c
SS
2173@end table
2174@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2175
474c8240 2176@smallexample
c906108c 2177(@value{GDBP}) info threads
6d2ebf8b
SS
2178 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2179 at quicksort.c:137
2180 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2181 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2182 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2183 from /usr/lib/libc.2
474c8240 2184@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2185
2186@table @code
2187@kindex thread @var{threadno}
2188@item thread @var{threadno}
2189Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2190argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2191shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2192@value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2193you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2194
2195@smallexample
2196@c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2197(@value{GDBP}) thread 2
c906108c 2198[Switching to process 35 thread 23]
c906108c
SS
21990x34e5 in sigpause ()
2200@end smallexample
2201
2202@noindent
2203As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2204@samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
5d161b24 2205threads.
c906108c
SS
2206
2207@kindex thread apply
2208@item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}
2209The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply a command to one or
2210more threads. Specify the numbers of the threads that you want affected
2211with the command argument @var{threadno}. @var{threadno} is the internal
2212@value{GDBN} thread number, as shown in the first field of the @samp{info
5d161b24
DB
2213threads} display. To apply a command to all threads, use
2214@code{thread apply all} @var{args}.
c906108c
SS
2215@end table
2216
2217@cindex automatic thread selection
2218@cindex switching threads automatically
2219@cindex threads, automatic switching
2220Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2221signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2222signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2223message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2224thread.
2225
2226@xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and starting multi-thread programs}, for
2227more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2228programs with multiple threads.
2229
2230@xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting watchpoints}, for information about
2231watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
c906108c 2232
6d2ebf8b 2233@node Processes
c906108c
SS
2234@section Debugging programs with multiple processes
2235
2236@cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2237@cindex multiple processes
2238@cindex processes, multiple
53a5351d
JM
2239On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2240programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2241function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2242parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2243set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2244will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2245will cause it to terminate.
c906108c
SS
2246
2247However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2248which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2249the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2250only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2251so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2252on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2253get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2254@value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
d4f3574e 2255the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
c906108c 2256the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
c906108c 2257
53a5351d
JM
2258On HP-UX (11.x and later only?), @value{GDBN} provides support for
2259debugging programs that create additional processes using the
2260@code{fork} or @code{vfork} function.
c906108c
SS
2261
2262By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2263the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2264
2265If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2266use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2267
2268@table @code
2269@kindex set follow-fork-mode
2270@item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2271Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2272@code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2273process. The @var{mode} can be:
2274
2275@table @code
2276@item parent
2277The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2df3850c 2278unimpeded. This is the default.
c906108c
SS
2279
2280@item child
2281The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2282unimpeded.
2283
2284@item ask
2285The debugger will ask for one of the above choices.
2286@end table
2287
2288@item show follow-fork-mode
2df3850c 2289Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
c906108c
SS
2290@end table
2291
2292If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2293@code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2294breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2295@code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2296the child process's @code{main}.
2297
2298When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2299child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2300
2301If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2302call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2303use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2304argument.
2305
2306You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2307a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2308Catchpoints, ,Setting catchpoints}.
c906108c 2309
6d2ebf8b 2310@node Stopping
c906108c
SS
2311@chapter Stopping and Continuing
2312
2313The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2314program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2315trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2316
7a292a7a
SS
2317Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2318such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2319@value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2320change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2321continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2322ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2323explicitly request this information at any time.
c906108c
SS
2324
2325@table @code
2326@kindex info program
2327@item info program
2328Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
7a292a7a 2329running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
c906108c
SS
2330@end table
2331
2332@menu
2333* Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2334* Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
c906108c 2335* Signals:: Signals
c906108c 2336* Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
c906108c
SS
2337@end menu
2338
6d2ebf8b 2339@node Breakpoints
c906108c
SS
2340@section Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2341
2342@cindex breakpoints
2343A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2344the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2345control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2346breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2347Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2348should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2349program.
2350
2351In HP-UX, SunOS 4.x, SVR4, and Alpha OSF/1 configurations, you can set
2352breakpoints in shared libraries before the executable is run. There is
2353a minor limitation on HP-UX systems: you must wait until the executable
2354is run in order to set breakpoints in shared library routines that are
2355not called directly by the program (for example, routines that are
2356arguments in a @code{pthread_create} call).
2357
2358@cindex watchpoints
2359@cindex memory tracing
2360@cindex breakpoint on memory address
2361@cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2362A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2363when the value of an expression changes. You must use a different
2364command to set watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting
2365watchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a watchpoint like
2366any other breakpoint: you enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints
2367and watchpoints using the same commands.
2368
2369You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2370whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2371Automatic display}.
2372
2373@cindex catchpoints
2374@cindex breakpoint on events
2375A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
b37052ae 2376when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
2377exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2378different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2379catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2380other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
d4f3574e 2381@code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
2382
2383@cindex breakpoint numbers
2384@cindex numbers for breakpoints
2385@value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2386catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2387starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2388features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2389breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2390@dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2391enable it again.
2392
c5394b80
JM
2393@cindex breakpoint ranges
2394@cindex ranges of breakpoints
2395Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2396operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2397@samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2398hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2399all breakpoint in that range are operated on.
2400
c906108c
SS
2401@menu
2402* Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2403* Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2404* Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2405* Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2406* Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2407* Conditions:: Break conditions
2408* Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
c906108c 2409* Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
d4f3574e 2410* Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
2411@end menu
2412
6d2ebf8b 2413@node Set Breaks
c906108c
SS
2414@subsection Setting breakpoints
2415
5d161b24 2416@c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
c906108c
SS
2417@c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2418@c
2419@c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2420
2421@kindex break
41afff9a
EZ
2422@kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2423@vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
2424@cindex latest breakpoint
2425Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
5d161b24 2426@code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
f3b28801 2427number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
c906108c
SS
2428Vars,, Convenience variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2429convenience variables.
2430
2431You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2432
2433@table @code
2434@item break @var{function}
5d161b24 2435Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
c906108c 2436When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
b37052ae 2437C@t{++}, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
c906108c 2438@xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
c906108c
SS
2439
2440@item break +@var{offset}
2441@itemx break -@var{offset}
2442Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
d4f3574e 2443at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2df3850c 2444(@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
c906108c
SS
2445
2446@item break @var{linenum}
2447Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
d4f3574e
SS
2448The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2449The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
c906108c
SS
2450code on that line.
2451
2452@item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2453Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2454
2455@item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2456Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2457@var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2458superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2459functions.
2460
2461@item break *@var{address}
2462Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2463breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2464information or source files.
2465
2466@item break
2467When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2468the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2469(@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2470innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2471returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2472@code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2473that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2474@code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2475the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2476inside loops.
2477
2478@value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2479least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2480would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2481breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2482existed when your program stopped.
2483
2484@item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2485Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2486@var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2487value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2488@samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2489above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2490,Break conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2491
2492@kindex tbreak
2493@item tbreak @var{args}
2494Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2495same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2496way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2497program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2498
c906108c
SS
2499@kindex hbreak
2500@item hbreak @var{args}
d4f3574e
SS
2501Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2502@code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
c906108c
SS
2503breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2504have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
d4f3574e
SS
2505debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2506changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2507provided by SPARClite DSU and some x86-based targets. These targets
2508will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2509address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2510breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2511example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2512@value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2513or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2514(@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling}). @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2515
2516@kindex thbreak
2517@item thbreak @var{args}
2518Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2519are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
5d161b24 2520the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
c906108c
SS
2521the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2522first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
5d161b24
DB
2523command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2524may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
d4f3574e 2525See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2526
2527@kindex rbreak
2528@cindex regular expression
2529@item rbreak @var{regex}
c906108c 2530Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
11cf8741
JM
2531@var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2532matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2533breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2534the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2535them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2536
2537The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2538like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2539shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2540an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2541@code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2542match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
c906108c 2543
b37052ae 2544When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
c906108c
SS
2545breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2546classes.
c906108c
SS
2547
2548@kindex info breakpoints
2549@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2550@item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2551@itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2552@itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2553Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2554not deleted, with the following columns for each breakpoint:
2555
2556@table @emph
2557@item Breakpoint Numbers
2558@item Type
2559Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2560@item Disposition
2561Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2562@item Enabled or Disabled
2563Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2564that are not enabled.
2565@item Address
2df3850c 2566Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address.
c906108c
SS
2567@item What
2568Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
2569line number.
2570@end table
2571
2572@noindent
2573If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
2574the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
2575are listed after that.
2576
2577@noindent
2578@code{info break} with a breakpoint
2579number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
2580convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
2581the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
5d161b24 2582listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).
c906108c
SS
2583
2584@noindent
2585@code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
2586has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
2587@code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
2588hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
2589was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
2590will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
2591@end table
2592
2593@value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
2594your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
2595the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
2596(@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
2597
2598@cindex negative breakpoint numbers
2599@cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
eb12ee30
AC
2600@value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
2601special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
2602programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
2603starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
c906108c 2604You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
eb12ee30 2605@samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
c906108c
SS
2606
2607
6d2ebf8b 2608@node Set Watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2609@subsection Setting watchpoints
2610
2611@cindex setting watchpoints
2612@cindex software watchpoints
2613@cindex hardware watchpoints
2614You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
2615expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
2616this may happen.
2617
2618Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
2df3850c 2619hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
c906108c
SS
2620program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
2621times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
2622catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
2623culprit.)
2624
1104b9e7 2625On some systems, such as HP-UX, @sc{gnu}/Linux and some other x86-based targets,
2df3850c 2626@value{GDBN} includes support for
c906108c
SS
2627hardware watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your
2628program.
2629
2630@table @code
2631@kindex watch
2632@item watch @var{expr}
2633Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when @var{expr}
2634is written into by the program and its value changes.
2635
2636@kindex rwatch
2637@item rwatch @var{expr}
2638Set a watchpoint that will break when watch @var{expr} is read by the program.
c906108c
SS
2639
2640@kindex awatch
2641@item awatch @var{expr}
2df3850c 2642Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read or written into
7be570e7 2643by the program.
c906108c
SS
2644
2645@kindex info watchpoints
2646@item info watchpoints
2647This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
2648it is the same as @code{info break}.
2649@end table
2650
2651@value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
2652watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
2653value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
2654cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
2655executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
2656statement, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
2657
2658When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
2659
474c8240 2660@smallexample
c906108c 2661Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
474c8240 2662@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2663
2664@noindent
2665if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
2666
7be570e7
JM
2667Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
2668hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
2669value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
2670every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
2671that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
2672hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
2673will print a message like this:
2674
2675@smallexample
2676Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
2677@end smallexample
2678
2679Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
2680data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
2681watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
2682can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
2683cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
2684double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
2685wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
2686into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
2687
2688If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
2689to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
2690Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
2691time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
2692able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
2693warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
2694
2695@smallexample
2696Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
2697@end smallexample
2698
2699@noindent
2700If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
2701
2702The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
2703or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
2704data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
2705hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
2706both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
2707watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
2708@strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
2709watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
c906108c
SS
2710@value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
2711Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
2712
2713If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
2df3850c 2714any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
c906108c
SS
2715kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
2716
7be570e7
JM
2717@value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
2718(automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
2719they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
2720which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
2721being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
2722and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
2723rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
2724way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
2725@code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
2726
c906108c
SS
2727@quotation
2728@cindex watchpoints and threads
2729@cindex threads and watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2730@emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
2731usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
2732can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
2733you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
2734thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
2735can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
2736@value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
2737the expression.
53a5351d 2738
d4f3574e 2739@c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
53a5351d
JM
2740@emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
2741have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
2742watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
2743single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
2744change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
2745confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
2746software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
2747when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
2748watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
c906108c 2749@end quotation
c906108c 2750
6d2ebf8b 2751@node Set Catchpoints
c906108c 2752@subsection Setting catchpoints
d4f3574e 2753@cindex catchpoints, setting
c906108c
SS
2754@cindex exception handlers
2755@cindex event handling
2756
2757You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
b37052ae 2758kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
c906108c
SS
2759shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
2760
2761@table @code
2762@kindex catch
2763@item catch @var{event}
2764Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
2765@table @code
2766@item throw
2767@kindex catch throw
b37052ae 2768The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
c906108c
SS
2769
2770@item catch
2771@kindex catch catch
b37052ae 2772The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
c906108c
SS
2773
2774@item exec
2775@kindex catch exec
2776A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2777
2778@item fork
2779@kindex catch fork
2780A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2781
2782@item vfork
2783@kindex catch vfork
2784A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2785
2786@item load
2787@itemx load @var{libname}
2788@kindex catch load
2789The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
2790@var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2791
2792@item unload
2793@itemx unload @var{libname}
2794@kindex catch unload
2795The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
2796of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2797@end table
2798
2799@item tcatch @var{event}
2800Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
2801automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
2802
2803@end table
2804
2805Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
2806
b37052ae 2807There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
c906108c
SS
2808(@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
2809
2810@itemize @bullet
2811@item
2812If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
2813control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
2814raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
2815returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
2816simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
2817that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
2818you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
2819disabled within interactive calls.
2820
2821@item
2822You cannot raise an exception interactively.
2823
2824@item
2825You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
2826@end itemize
2827
2828@cindex raise exceptions
2829Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
2830if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
2831stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
2832can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
2833breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
2834out where the exception was raised.
2835
2836To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
b37052ae 2837knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
c906108c
SS
2838raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
2839which has the following ANSI C interface:
2840
474c8240 2841@smallexample
c906108c 2842 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
d4f3574e
SS
2843 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
2844 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
474c8240 2845@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2846
2847@noindent
2848To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
2849unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
2850(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and exceptions}).
2851
2852With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions})
2853that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
2854a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
2855breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
2856raised.
2857
2858
6d2ebf8b 2859@node Delete Breaks
c906108c
SS
2860@subsection Deleting breakpoints
2861
2862@cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2863@cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2864It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2865catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
2866to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
2867breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
2868
2869With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
2870where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
2871delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
2872their breakpoint numbers.
2873
2874It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
2875automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
2876when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
2877
2878@table @code
2879@kindex clear
2880@item clear
2881Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
2882selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). When
2883the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
2884breakpoint where your program just stopped.
2885
2886@item clear @var{function}
2887@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
2888Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the function @var{function}.
2889
2890@item clear @var{linenum}
2891@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2892Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified line.
2893
2894@cindex delete breakpoints
2895@kindex delete
41afff9a 2896@kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
c5394b80
JM
2897@item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2898Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
2899ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
c906108c
SS
2900breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
2901confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
2902@end table
2903
6d2ebf8b 2904@node Disabling
c906108c
SS
2905@subsection Disabling breakpoints
2906
2907@kindex disable breakpoints
2908@kindex enable breakpoints
2909Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
2910prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
2911it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
2912that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
2913
2914You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
2915the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
2916or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
2917@code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
2918catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
2919
2920A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
2921states of enablement:
2922
2923@itemize @bullet
2924@item
2925Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
2926with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
2927@item
2928Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
2929@item
2930Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
d4f3574e 2931disabled.
c906108c
SS
2932@item
2933Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
d4f3574e
SS
2934immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
2935set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
c906108c
SS
2936@end itemize
2937
2938You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
2939watchpoints, and catchpoints:
2940
2941@table @code
2942@kindex disable breakpoints
2943@kindex disable
41afff9a 2944@kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
c5394b80 2945@item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
2946Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
2947listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
2948options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
2949case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
2950@code{disable} as @code{dis}.
2951
2952@kindex enable breakpoints
2953@kindex enable
c5394b80 2954@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
2955Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
2956become effective once again in stopping your program.
2957
c5394b80 2958@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
c906108c
SS
2959Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
2960of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
2961
c5394b80 2962@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
c906108c
SS
2963Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
2964deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
2965@end table
2966
d4f3574e
SS
2967@c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
2968@c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
c906108c
SS
2969Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
2970,Setting breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
2971subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
2972the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
2973breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
2974breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
2975stepping}.)
2976
6d2ebf8b 2977@node Conditions
c906108c
SS
2978@subsection Break conditions
2979@cindex conditional breakpoints
2980@cindex breakpoint conditions
2981
2982@c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
5d161b24 2983@c in particular for a watchpoint?
c906108c
SS
2984The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
2985specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
2986breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
2987programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
2988a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
2989and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
2990
2991This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
2992situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
2993when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
2994by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
2995@samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
2996
2997Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
2998since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
2999it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
3000and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
3001one.
3002
3003Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
3004your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
3005that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
3006format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
3007unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
3008that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
3009program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
d4f3574e
SS
3010breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
3011conditions for the
c906108c
SS
3012purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
3013(@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint command lists}).
3014
3015Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
3016@samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
3017Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3018with the @code{condition} command.
53a5351d 3019
c906108c
SS
3020You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3021The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3022@code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3023catchpoint.
c906108c
SS
3024
3025@table @code
3026@kindex condition
3027@item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3028Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3029watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3030breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3031@var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3032@code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3033syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
d4f3574e
SS
3034referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3035symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3036prints an error message:
3037
474c8240 3038@smallexample
d4f3574e 3039No symbol "foo" in current context.
474c8240 3040@end smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
3041
3042@noindent
c906108c
SS
3043@value{GDBN} does
3044not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
d4f3574e
SS
3045command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3046@code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
c906108c
SS
3047
3048@item condition @var{bnum}
3049Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3050an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3051@end table
3052
3053@cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3054A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3055breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3056useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3057count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3058is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3059therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3060ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3061the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3062value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3063your program reaches it.
3064
3065@table @code
3066@kindex ignore
3067@item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3068Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3069The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3070execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3071takes no action.
3072
3073To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3074a count of zero.
3075
3076When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3077breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3078@code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3079Stepping,,Continuing and stepping}.
3080
3081If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3082condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3083@value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3084
3085You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3086as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3087is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3088variables}.
3089@end table
3090
3091Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3092
3093
6d2ebf8b 3094@node Break Commands
c906108c
SS
3095@subsection Breakpoint command lists
3096
3097@cindex breakpoint commands
3098You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3099commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3100example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3101enable other breakpoints.
3102
3103@table @code
3104@kindex commands
3105@kindex end
3106@item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3107@itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3108@itemx end
3109Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3110themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3111@code{end} to terminate the commands.
3112
3113To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3114follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3115
3116With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3117breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3118recently encountered).
3119@end table
3120
3121Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3122disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3123
3124You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3125use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3126that resumes execution.
3127
3128Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3129execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3130(even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3131another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3132ambiguities about which list to execute.
3133
3134@kindex silent
3135If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3136usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3137be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3138then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3139see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3140meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3141
3142The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3143print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3144breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for controlled output}.
3145
3146For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3147value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3148
474c8240 3149@smallexample
c906108c
SS
3150break foo if x>0
3151commands
3152silent
3153printf "x is %d\n",x
3154cont
3155end
474c8240 3156@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
3157
3158One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3159you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3160of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3161erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3162to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3163so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3164command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3165
474c8240 3166@smallexample
c906108c
SS
3167break 403
3168commands
3169silent
3170set x = y + 4
3171cont
3172end
474c8240 3173@end smallexample
c906108c 3174
6d2ebf8b 3175@node Breakpoint Menus
c906108c
SS
3176@subsection Breakpoint menus
3177@cindex overloading
3178@cindex symbol overloading
3179
b37052ae 3180Some programming languages (notably C@t{++}) permit a single function name
c906108c
SS
3181to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3182This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3183@samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3184a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
3185something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
3186particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3187you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3188waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3189options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3190sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3191@kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3192breakpoints.
3193
3194For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3195breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3196We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3197
3198@c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3199@smallexample
3200@group
3201(@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3202[0] cancel
3203[1] all
3204[2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3205[3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3206[4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3207[5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3208[6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3209[7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3210> 2 4 6
3211Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3212Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3213Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3214Multiple breakpoints were set.
3215Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3216 breakpoints.
3217(@value{GDBP})
3218@end group
3219@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
3220
3221@c @ifclear BARETARGET
6d2ebf8b 3222@node Error in Breakpoints
d4f3574e 3223@subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
3224@c
3225@c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3226@c
d4f3574e
SS
3227Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3228any other process is running that program. In this situation,
5d161b24 3229attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
d4f3574e
SS
3230@value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3231
474c8240 3232@smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
3233Cannot insert breakpoints.
3234The same program may be running in another process.
474c8240 3235@end smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
3236
3237When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3238
3239@enumerate
3240@item
3241Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3242
3243@item
5d161b24 3244Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
d4f3574e 3245name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
5d161b24 3246that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
d4f3574e
SS
3247Then start your program again.
3248
3249@item
3250Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3251linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3252to nonsharable executables.
3253@end enumerate
c906108c
SS
3254@c @end ifclear
3255
d4f3574e
SS
3256A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3257hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3258
3259@c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3260@c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3261@smallexample
3262Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3263You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3264@end smallexample
3265
3266@noindent
3267This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3268only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3269watchpoints it needs to insert.
3270
3271When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3272hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3273
3274
6d2ebf8b 3275@node Continuing and Stepping
c906108c
SS
3276@section Continuing and stepping
3277
3278@cindex stepping
3279@cindex continuing
3280@cindex resuming execution
3281@dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3282completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3283one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3284line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
7a292a7a
SS
3285particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3286your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
d4f3574e
SS
3287it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3288@samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
3289
3290@table @code
3291@kindex continue
41afff9a
EZ
3292@kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3293@kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
c906108c
SS
3294@item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3295@itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3296@itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3297Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3298any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3299@var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3300ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3301@code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3302
3303The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3304stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3305@code{continue} is ignored.
3306
d4f3574e
SS
3307The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3308debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3309purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3310@code{continue}.
c906108c
SS
3311@end table
3312
3313To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3314(@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}) to go back to the
3315calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3316different address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3317
3318A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3319(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and catchpoints}) at the
3320beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3321is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3322and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3323interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3324
3325@table @code
3326@kindex step
41afff9a 3327@kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
c906108c
SS
3328@item step
3329Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3330line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3331abbreviated @code{s}.
3332
3333@quotation
3334@c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3335@c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3336@c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3337@c distinction here.
3338@emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3339within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3340execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3341debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3342is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3343without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3344below.
3345@end quotation
3346
4a92d011
EZ
3347The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
3348line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3349@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
3350to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
3351the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
3352called within the line.
c906108c 3353
d4f3574e
SS
3354Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
3355number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5d161b24 3356@code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
c906108c 3357on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5d161b24 3358was any debugging information about the routine.
c906108c
SS
3359
3360@item step @var{count}
3361Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
7a292a7a
SS
3362breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3363@var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
c906108c
SS
3364
3365@kindex next
41afff9a 3366@kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
c906108c
SS
3367@item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
3368Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
7a292a7a
SS
3369This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
3370the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
3371control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
3372that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
3373is abbreviated @code{n}.
c906108c
SS
3374
3375An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
3376
3377
3378@c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
3379@c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
3380@c
3381@c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
3382@c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
3383@c function are executed without stopping.
3384
d4f3574e
SS
3385The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3386source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4a92d011 3387@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
c906108c 3388
b90a5f51
CF
3389@kindex set step-mode
3390@item set step-mode
3391@cindex functions without line info, and stepping
3392@cindex stepping into functions with no line info
3393@itemx set step-mode on
4a92d011 3394The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
b90a5f51
CF
3395stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
3396information rather than stepping over it.
3397
4a92d011
EZ
3398This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
3399machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
3400want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
b90a5f51
CF
3401
3402@item set step-mode off
4a92d011 3403Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
b90a5f51
CF
3404debug information. This is the default.
3405
c906108c
SS
3406@kindex finish
3407@item finish
3408Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
3409returns. Print the returned value (if any).
3410
3411Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
3412,Returning from a function}).
3413
3414@kindex until
41afff9a 3415@kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
c906108c
SS
3416@item until
3417@itemx u
3418Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
3419current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
3420stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
3421command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
3422automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
3423than the address of the jump.
3424
3425This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
3426though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
3427exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
3428simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
3429through the next iteration.
3430
3431@code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
3432stack frame.
3433
3434@code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
3435of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
3436example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
3437(@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
3438@code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
3439
474c8240 3440@smallexample
c906108c
SS
3441(@value{GDBP}) f
3442#0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
3443206 expand_input();
3444(@value{GDBP}) until
3445195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
474c8240 3446@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
3447
3448This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
3449generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
3450start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
3451written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
3452to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
3453expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
3454statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
3455
3456@code{until} with no argument works by means of single
3457instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
3458argument.
3459
3460@item until @var{location}
3461@itemx u @var{location}
3462Continue running your program until either the specified location is
3463reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
3464the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
c60eb6f1
EZ
3465,Setting breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints, and
3466hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
3467location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
3468implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
3469invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
3470line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
3471line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e. after the inner
3472invocations have returned.
3473
3474@smallexample
347594 int factorial (int value)
347695 @{
347796 if (value > 1) @{
347897 value *= factorial (value - 1);
347998 @}
348099 return (value);
3481100 @}
3482@end smallexample
3483
3484
3485@kindex advance @var{location}
3486@itemx advance @var{location}
3487Continue running the program up to the given location. An argument is
3488required, anything of the same form as arguments for the @code{break}
3489command. Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
3490frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
3491not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
3492have to be in the same frame as the current one.
3493
c906108c
SS
3494
3495@kindex stepi
41afff9a 3496@kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
c906108c 3497@item stepi
96a2c332 3498@itemx stepi @var{arg}
c906108c
SS
3499@itemx si
3500Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
3501
3502It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
3503instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
3504instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
3505Display,, Automatic display}.
3506
3507An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
3508
3509@need 750
3510@kindex nexti
41afff9a 3511@kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
c906108c 3512@item nexti
96a2c332 3513@itemx nexti @var{arg}
c906108c
SS
3514@itemx ni
3515Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
3516proceed until the function returns.
3517
3518An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
3519@end table
3520
6d2ebf8b 3521@node Signals
c906108c
SS
3522@section Signals
3523@cindex signals
3524
3525A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
3526operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
3527kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
d4f3574e 3528signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{C-c});
c906108c
SS
3529@code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
3530memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
3531the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
3532requested an alarm).
3533
3534@cindex fatal signals
3535Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
3536functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
d4f3574e 3537errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
c906108c
SS
3538program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
3539@code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
3540fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
3541
3542@value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
3543program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
3544signal.
3545
3546@cindex handling signals
24f93129
EZ
3547Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
3548@code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
3549(so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
c906108c
SS
3550but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
3551You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
3552
3553@table @code
3554@kindex info signals
3555@item info signals
96a2c332 3556@itemx info handle
c906108c
SS
3557Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
3558handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
3559the defined types of signals.
3560
d4f3574e 3561@code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
c906108c
SS
3562
3563@kindex handle
3564@item handle @var{signal} @var{keywords}@dots{}
5ece1a18
EZ
3565Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
3566can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
24f93129 3567@samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5ece1a18
EZ
3568@samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
3569known signals. The @var{keywords} say what change to make.
c906108c
SS
3570@end table
3571
3572@c @group
3573The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
3574Their full names are:
3575
3576@table @code
3577@item nostop
3578@value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
3579still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
3580
3581@item stop
3582@value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
3583the @code{print} keyword as well.
3584
3585@item print
3586@value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
3587
3588@item noprint
3589@value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
3590implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
3591
3592@item pass
5ece1a18 3593@itemx noignore
c906108c
SS
3594@value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
3595can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5ece1a18 3596and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
c906108c
SS
3597
3598@item nopass
5ece1a18 3599@itemx ignore
c906108c 3600@value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5ece1a18 3601@code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
c906108c
SS
3602@end table
3603@c @end group
3604
d4f3574e
SS
3605When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
3606program until you
c906108c
SS
3607continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
3608effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
3609after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
3610command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
3611program sees that signal when you continue.
3612
24f93129
EZ
3613The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
3614non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
3615@code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
3616erroneous signals.
3617
c906108c
SS
3618You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
3619seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
3620or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
3621due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
3622values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
3623execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
3624a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
3625you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5d161b24 3626program a signal}.
c906108c 3627
6d2ebf8b 3628@node Thread Stops
c906108c
SS
3629@section Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3630
3631When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
3632programs with multiple threads}), you can choose whether to set
3633breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
3634
3635@table @code
3636@cindex breakpoints and threads
3637@cindex thread breakpoints
3638@kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
3639@item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
3640@itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
3641@var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
3642writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
3643
3644Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
3645to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
3646particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
3647numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
3648column of the @samp{info threads} display.
3649
3650If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
3651breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
3652program.
3653
3654You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
3655well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
3656breakpoint condition, like this:
3657
3658@smallexample
2df3850c 3659(@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
c906108c
SS
3660@end smallexample
3661
3662@end table
3663
3664@cindex stopped threads
3665@cindex threads, stopped
3666Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
3667@emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
3668allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
3669switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
3670underfoot.
3671
3672@cindex continuing threads
3673@cindex threads, continuing
3674Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
3675executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5d161b24 3676like @code{step} or @code{next}.
c906108c
SS
3677
3678In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
3679Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
3680system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
3681execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
3682single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
3683statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
3684stops.
3685
3686You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
3687continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
3688thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
3689first thread completes whatever you requested.
3690
3691On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
3692thread to run.
3693
3694@table @code
3695@item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
3696Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
3697locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
3698current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
3699mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
3700``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
3701stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
d4f3574e 3702when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
c906108c 3703function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
d4f3574e 3704like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
c906108c 3705thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
2df3850c 3706@value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
c906108c
SS
3707
3708@item show scheduler-locking
3709Display the current scheduler locking mode.
3710@end table
3711
c906108c 3712
6d2ebf8b 3713@node Stack
c906108c
SS
3714@chapter Examining the Stack
3715
3716When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
3717stopped and how it got there.
3718
3719@cindex call stack
5d161b24
DB
3720Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
3721is generated.
3722That information includes the location of the call in your program,
3723the arguments of the call,
c906108c 3724and the local variables of the function being called.
5d161b24 3725The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
c906108c
SS
3726The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
3727stack}.
3728
3729When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
3730stack allow you to see all of this information.
3731
3732@cindex selected frame
3733One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
3734@value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
3735particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
3736your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
3737special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
3738interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3739
3740When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
5d161b24 3741currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
c906108c
SS
3742@code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}).
3743
3744@menu
3745* Frames:: Stack frames
3746* Backtrace:: Backtraces
3747* Selection:: Selecting a frame
3748* Frame Info:: Information on a frame
c906108c
SS
3749
3750@end menu
3751
6d2ebf8b 3752@node Frames
c906108c
SS
3753@section Stack frames
3754
d4f3574e 3755@cindex frame, definition
c906108c
SS
3756@cindex stack frame
3757The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
3758frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
3759with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
3760to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
3761which the function is executing.
3762
3763@cindex initial frame
3764@cindex outermost frame
3765@cindex innermost frame
3766When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
3767function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
3768@dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
3769made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
3770is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
3771the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
3772actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
3773recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
3774
3775@cindex frame pointer
3776Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
3777stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
3778kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
3779address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
3780in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register} while execution is
3781going on in that frame.
3782
3783@cindex frame number
3784@value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
3785zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
3786and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
3787they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
3788frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
3789
6d2ebf8b
SS
3790@c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
3791@c underflow problems.
c906108c
SS
3792@cindex frameless execution
3793Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
6d2ebf8b 3794without stack frames. (For example, the @value{GCC} option
474c8240 3795@smallexample
6d2ebf8b 3796@samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
474c8240 3797@end smallexample
6d2ebf8b 3798generates functions without a frame.)
c906108c
SS
3799This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
3800the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
3801with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
3802has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
3803it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
3804correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
3805no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
3806
3807@table @code
d4f3574e 3808@kindex frame@r{, command}
41afff9a 3809@cindex current stack frame
c906108c 3810@item frame @var{args}
5d161b24 3811The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
c906108c 3812and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
5d161b24
DB
3813address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
3814@code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
c906108c
SS
3815
3816@kindex select-frame
41afff9a 3817@cindex selecting frame silently
c906108c
SS
3818@item select-frame
3819The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
3820to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
3821@code{frame}.
3822@end table
3823
6d2ebf8b 3824@node Backtrace
c906108c
SS
3825@section Backtraces
3826
3827@cindex backtraces
3828@cindex tracebacks
3829@cindex stack traces
3830A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
3831line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
3832frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
3833stack.
3834
3835@table @code
3836@kindex backtrace
41afff9a 3837@kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
c906108c
SS
3838@item backtrace
3839@itemx bt
3840Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
3841frames in the stack.
3842
3843You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
3844character, normally @kbd{C-c}.
3845
3846@item backtrace @var{n}
3847@itemx bt @var{n}
3848Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
3849
3850@item backtrace -@var{n}
3851@itemx bt -@var{n}
3852Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
3853@end table
3854
3855@kindex where
3856@kindex info stack
41afff9a 3857@kindex info s @r{(@code{info stack})}
c906108c
SS
3858The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
3859are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
3860
3861Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
3862The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
3863print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
3864line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
3865counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
3866line number.
3867
3868Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
3869@samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
3870
3871@smallexample
3872@group
5d161b24 3873#0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
c906108c
SS
3874 at builtin.c:993
3875#1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
3876#2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
3877 at macro.c:71
3878(More stack frames follow...)
3879@end group
3880@end smallexample
3881
3882@noindent
3883The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
3884value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
3885code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
3886
b4e9345d
DJ
3887@kindex set backtrace-below-main
3888@kindex show backtrace-below-main
3889
95f90d25
DJ
3890Most programs have a standard entry point---a place where system libraries
3891and startup code transition into user code. For C this is @code{main}.
3892When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace it will terminate
3893the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly system-specific (and generally
3894uninteresting) code. If you need to examine the startup code, then you can
3895change this behavior.
3896
3897@table @code
3898@item set backtrace-below-main off
3899Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
3900default.
3901
3902@item set backtrace-below-main
3903@itemx set backtrace-below-main on
3904Backtraces will continue past the user entry point to the top of the stack.
3905
3906@item show backtrace-below-main
3907Display the current backtrace policy.
3908@end table
3909
6d2ebf8b 3910@node Selection
c906108c
SS
3911@section Selecting a frame
3912
3913Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
3914whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
3915selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
3916of the stack frame just selected.
3917
3918@table @code
d4f3574e 3919@kindex frame@r{, selecting}
41afff9a 3920@kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
c906108c
SS
3921@item frame @var{n}
3922@itemx f @var{n}
3923Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
3924(currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
3925innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
3926@code{main}.
3927
3928@item frame @var{addr}
3929@itemx f @var{addr}
3930Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
3931chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
3932impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
3933addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
3934switches between them.
3935
c906108c
SS
3936On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
3937select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
3938
3939On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
3940pointer and a program counter.
3941
3942On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
3943pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
3944@c note to future updaters: this is conditioned on a flag
3945@c SETUP_ARBITRARY_FRAME in the tm-*.h files. The above is up to date
3946@c as of 27 Jan 1994.
c906108c
SS
3947
3948@kindex up
3949@item up @var{n}
3950Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3951advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
3952that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
3953
3954@kindex down
41afff9a 3955@kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
c906108c
SS
3956@item down @var{n}
3957Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3958advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
3959that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
3960abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
3961@end table
3962
3963All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
3964frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
3965arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
5d161b24 3966frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
c906108c
SS
3967
3968@need 1000
3969For example:
3970
3971@smallexample
3972@group
3973(@value{GDBP}) up
3974#1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
3975 at env.c:10
397610 read_input_file (argv[i]);
3977@end group
3978@end smallexample
3979
3980After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
3981prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
87885426
FN
3982You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
3983editing program by typing @code{edit}.
3984@xref{List, ,Printing source lines},
3985for details.
c906108c
SS
3986
3987@table @code
3988@kindex down-silently
3989@kindex up-silently
3990@item up-silently @var{n}
3991@itemx down-silently @var{n}
3992These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
3993respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
3994causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
3995in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
3996distracting.
3997@end table
3998
6d2ebf8b 3999@node Frame Info
c906108c
SS
4000@section Information about a frame
4001
4002There are several other commands to print information about the selected
4003stack frame.
4004
4005@table @code
4006@item frame
4007@itemx f
4008When used without any argument, this command does not change which
4009frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
4010selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
4011argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
4012@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4013
4014@kindex info frame
41afff9a 4015@kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
c906108c
SS
4016@item info frame
4017@itemx info f
4018This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
4019including:
4020
4021@itemize @bullet
5d161b24
DB
4022@item
4023the address of the frame
c906108c
SS
4024@item
4025the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
4026@item
4027the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
4028@item
4029the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
4030@item
4031the address of the frame's arguments
4032@item
d4f3574e
SS
4033the address of the frame's local variables
4034@item
c906108c
SS
4035the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
4036@item
4037which registers were saved in the frame
4038@end itemize
4039
4040@noindent The verbose description is useful when
4041something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
4042the usual conventions.
4043
4044@item info frame @var{addr}
4045@itemx info f @var{addr}
4046Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
4047selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
4048command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
4049architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
4050@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4051
4052@kindex info args
4053@item info args
4054Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
4055
4056@item info locals
4057@kindex info locals
4058Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
4059line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
4060accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
4061
c906108c 4062@kindex info catch
d4f3574e
SS
4063@cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
4064@cindex exception handlers, how to list
c906108c
SS
4065@item info catch
4066Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
4067current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
4068exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
4069@code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
4070@xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
53a5351d 4071
c906108c
SS
4072@end table
4073
c906108c 4074
6d2ebf8b 4075@node Source
c906108c
SS
4076@chapter Examining Source Files
4077
4078@value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
4079information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
4080used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
4081the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
4082(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
4083execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
4084source files by explicit command.
4085
7a292a7a 4086If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
d4f3574e 4087prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7a292a7a 4088@value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
c906108c
SS
4089
4090@menu
4091* List:: Printing source lines
87885426 4092* Edit:: Editing source files
c906108c 4093* Search:: Searching source files
c906108c
SS
4094* Source Path:: Specifying source directories
4095* Machine Code:: Source and machine code
4096@end menu
4097
6d2ebf8b 4098@node List
c906108c
SS
4099@section Printing source lines
4100
4101@kindex list
41afff9a 4102@kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
c906108c 4103To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
5d161b24 4104(abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
c906108c
SS
4105There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
4106
4107Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
4108
4109@table @code
4110@item list @var{linenum}
4111Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
4112current source file.
4113
4114@item list @var{function}
4115Print lines centered around the beginning of function
4116@var{function}.
4117
4118@item list
4119Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
4120@code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
4121printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
4122as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4123Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4124
4125@item list -
4126Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4127@end table
4128
4129By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4130the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4131
4132@table @code
4133@kindex set listsize
4134@item set listsize @var{count}
4135Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4136the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4137
4138@kindex show listsize
4139@item show listsize
4140Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4141@end table
4142
4143Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4144so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4145than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4146argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4147each repetition moves up in the source file.
4148
4149@cindex linespec
4150In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4151@dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
d4f3574e 4152of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
c906108c
SS
4153Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4154
4155@table @code
4156@item list @var{linespec}
4157Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4158
4159@item list @var{first},@var{last}
4160Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4161linespecs.
4162
4163@item list ,@var{last}
4164Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4165
4166@item list @var{first},
4167Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4168
4169@item list +
4170Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4171
4172@item list -
4173Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4174
4175@item list
4176As described in the preceding table.
4177@end table
4178
4179Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
4180kinds of linespec.
4181
4182@table @code
4183@item @var{number}
4184Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
4185When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
4186the same source file as the first linespec.
4187
4188@item +@var{offset}
4189Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
4190When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
4191two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
4192first linespec.
4193
4194@item -@var{offset}
4195Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
4196
4197@item @var{filename}:@var{number}
4198Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4199
4200@item @var{function}
4201Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
4202For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
4203
4204@item @var{filename}:@var{function}
4205Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
4206function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4207file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4208identically named functions in different source files.
4209
4210@item *@var{address}
4211Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4212@var{address} may be any expression.
4213@end table
4214
87885426
FN
4215@node Edit
4216@section Editing source files
4217@cindex editing source files
4218
4219@kindex edit
4220@kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
4221To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
4222The editing program of your choice
4223is invoked with the current line set to
4224the active line in the program.
4225Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
4226want to print if you want to see other parts of the program.
4227
4228Here are the forms of the @code{edit} command most commonly used:
4229
4230@table @code
4231@item edit
4232Edit the current source file at the active line number in the program.
4233
4234@item edit @var{number}
4235Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
4236
4237@item edit @var{function}
4238Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
4239
4240@item edit @var{filename}:@var{number}
4241Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4242
4243@item edit @var{filename}:@var{function}
4244Specifies the line that begins the body of the
4245function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4246file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4247identically named functions in different source files.
4248
4249@item edit *@var{address}
4250Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4251@var{address} may be any expression.
4252@end table
4253
4254@subsection Choosing your editor
4255You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
4256@footnote{
4257The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
4258following command-line syntax:
10998722 4259@smallexample
87885426 4260ex +@var{number} file
10998722
AC
4261@end smallexample
4262The optional numeric value +@var{number} designates the active line in
4263the file.}. By default, it is @value{EDITOR}, but you can change this
4264by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
4265@value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
4266@code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
4267@smallexample
87885426
FN
4268EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
4269export EDITOR
4270gdb ...
10998722 4271@end smallexample
87885426 4272or in the @code{csh} shell,
10998722 4273@smallexample
87885426
FN
4274setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
4275gdb ...
10998722 4276@end smallexample
87885426 4277
6d2ebf8b 4278@node Search
c906108c
SS
4279@section Searching source files
4280@cindex searching
4281@kindex reverse-search
4282
4283There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
4284regular expression.
4285
4286@table @code
4287@kindex search
4288@kindex forward-search
4289@item forward-search @var{regexp}
4290@itemx search @var{regexp}
4291The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
4292starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
5d161b24 4293@var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
c906108c
SS
4294synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
4295@code{fo}.
4296
4297@item reverse-search @var{regexp}
4298The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
4299with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
4300for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
4301this command as @code{rev}.
4302@end table
c906108c 4303
6d2ebf8b 4304@node Source Path
c906108c
SS
4305@section Specifying source directories
4306
4307@cindex source path
4308@cindex directories for source files
4309Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
4310files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
4311the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
4312session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
4313this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
4314it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
4315in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name. Note that
4316the executable search path is @emph{not} used for this purpose. Neither is
4317the current working directory, unless it happens to be in the source
4318path.
4319
4320If @value{GDBN} cannot find a source file in the source path, and the
4321object program records a directory, @value{GDBN} tries that directory
4322too. If the source path is empty, and there is no record of the
4323compilation directory, @value{GDBN} looks in the current directory as a
4324last resort.
4325
4326Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
4327any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
4328each line is in the file.
4329
4330@kindex directory
4331@kindex dir
d4f3574e
SS
4332When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
4333and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
c906108c
SS
4334To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
4335
4336@table @code
4337@item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
4338@item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
4339Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
d4f3574e
SS
4340directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
4341(@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
4342part of absolute file names) or
c906108c
SS
4343whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
4344path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
4345
4346@kindex cdir
4347@kindex cwd
41afff9a
EZ
4348@vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
4349@vindex $cwdr@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
4350@cindex compilation directory
4351@cindex current directory
4352@cindex working directory
4353@cindex directory, current
4354@cindex directory, compilation
4355You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
4356directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
4357working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
4358tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
4359session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
4360directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
4361
4362@item directory
4363Reset the source path to empty again. This requires confirmation.
4364
4365@c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
4366@c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
4367
4368@item show directories
4369@kindex show directories
4370Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
4371@end table
4372
4373If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
4374interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
4375versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
4376
4377@enumerate
4378@item
4379Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to empty.
4380
4381@item
4382Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
4383directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
4384directories in one command.
4385@end enumerate
4386
6d2ebf8b 4387@node Machine Code
c906108c
SS
4388@section Source and machine code
4389
4390You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
4391addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
4392a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
d4f3574e 4393mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5d161b24 4394line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
c906108c
SS
4395well as hex.
4396
4397@table @code
4398@kindex info line
4399@item info line @var{linespec}
4400Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
4401source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
4402the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
4403source lines}).
4404@end table
4405
4406For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
4407the object code for the first line of function
4408@code{m4_changequote}:
4409
d4f3574e
SS
4410@c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
4411@c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
c906108c 4412@smallexample
96a2c332 4413(@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
c906108c
SS
4414Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
4415@end smallexample
4416
4417@noindent
4418We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
4419@var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
4420@smallexample
4421(@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
4422Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
4423@end smallexample
4424
4425@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
41afff9a 4426@kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
c906108c
SS
4427After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
4428is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
4429sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
4430,Examining memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
4431convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4432variables}).
4433
4434@table @code
4435@kindex disassemble
4436@cindex assembly instructions
4437@cindex instructions, assembly
4438@cindex machine instructions
4439@cindex listing machine instructions
4440@item disassemble
4441This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
4442instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
4443program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
4444command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
4445surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
4446(first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
4447@end table
4448
c906108c
SS
4449The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
4450HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
4451
4452@smallexample
4453(@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
4454Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
44550x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
44560x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
44570x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
44580x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
44590x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
44600x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
44610x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
44620x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4463End of assembler dump.
4464@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4465
4466Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
4467mnemonics or other syntax.
4468
4469@table @code
d4f3574e 4470@kindex set disassembly-flavor
c906108c
SS
4471@cindex assembly instructions
4472@cindex instructions, assembly
4473@cindex machine instructions
4474@cindex listing machine instructions
d4f3574e
SS
4475@cindex Intel disassembly flavor
4476@cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
4477@item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
c906108c
SS
4478Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
4479program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
4480
4481Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
d4f3574e
SS
4482can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
4483The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
4484assemblers for x86-based targets.
c906108c
SS
4485@end table
4486
4487
6d2ebf8b 4488@node Data
c906108c
SS
4489@chapter Examining Data
4490
4491@cindex printing data
4492@cindex examining data
4493@kindex print
4494@kindex inspect
4495@c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
4496@c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
4497@c different window or something like that.
4498The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
7a292a7a
SS
4499command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
4500evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
4501program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
4502Different Languages}).
c906108c
SS
4503
4504@table @code
d4f3574e
SS
4505@item print @var{expr}
4506@itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
4507@var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
4508value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
c906108c 4509you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
d4f3574e 4510@var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
c906108c
SS
4511formats}.
4512
4513@item print
4514@itemx print /@var{f}
d4f3574e 4515If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
c906108c
SS
4516@dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value history}). This allows you to
4517conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
4518@end table
4519
4520A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
4521It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
4522specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4523
7a292a7a 4524If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
d4f3574e
SS
4525fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
4526command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
7a292a7a 4527Table}.
c906108c
SS
4528
4529@menu
4530* Expressions:: Expressions
4531* Variables:: Program variables
4532* Arrays:: Artificial arrays
4533* Output Formats:: Output formats
4534* Memory:: Examining memory
4535* Auto Display:: Automatic display
4536* Print Settings:: Print settings
4537* Value History:: Value history
4538* Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
4539* Registers:: Registers
c906108c 4540* Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
53c69bd7 4541* Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
29e57380 4542* Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
16d9dec6 4543* Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
a0eb71c5
KB
4544* Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
4545 character set than GDB does
c906108c
SS
4546@end menu
4547
6d2ebf8b 4548@node Expressions
c906108c
SS
4549@section Expressions
4550
4551@cindex expressions
4552@code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
4553compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
4554by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
e2e0bcd1
JB
4555@value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
4556casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
4557you compiled your program to include this information; see
4558@ref{Compilation}.
c906108c 4559
d4f3574e
SS
4560@value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
4561the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
5d161b24 4562you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
d4f3574e 4563memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
c906108c 4564
c906108c
SS
4565Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
4566this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
4567Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
4568languages.
4569
4570In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
4571expressions regardless of your programming language.
4572
4573Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
4574useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
4575at that address in memory.
4576@c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
c906108c
SS
4577
4578@value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
4579to programming languages:
4580
4581@table @code
4582@item @@
4583@samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
4584@xref{Arrays, ,Artificial arrays}, for more information.
4585
4586@item ::
4587@samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
4588function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program variables}.
4589
4590@cindex @{@var{type}@}
4591@cindex type casting memory
4592@cindex memory, viewing as typed object
4593@cindex casts, to view memory
4594@item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
4595Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
4596memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
4597pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
4598a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
4599normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
4600@end table
4601
6d2ebf8b 4602@node Variables
c906108c
SS
4603@section Program variables
4604
4605The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
4606in your program.
4607
4608Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
4609(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}); they must be either:
4610
4611@itemize @bullet
4612@item
4613global (or file-static)
4614@end itemize
4615
5d161b24 4616@noindent or
c906108c
SS
4617
4618@itemize @bullet
4619@item
4620visible according to the scope rules of the
4621programming language from the point of execution in that frame
5d161b24 4622@end itemize
c906108c
SS
4623
4624@noindent This means that in the function
4625
474c8240 4626@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4627foo (a)
4628 int a;
4629@{
4630 bar (a);
4631 @{
4632 int b = test ();
4633 bar (b);
4634 @}
4635@}
474c8240 4636@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4637
4638@noindent
4639you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
4640executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
4641examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
4642the block where @code{b} is declared.
4643
4644@cindex variable name conflict
4645There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
4646scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
4647in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
4648function with the same name (in different source files). If that
4649happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
4650you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
4651using the colon-colon notation:
4652
d4f3574e 4653@cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
c906108c
SS
4654@iftex
4655@c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
41afff9a 4656@cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
c906108c 4657@end iftex
474c8240 4658@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4659@var{file}::@var{variable}
4660@var{function}::@var{variable}
474c8240 4661@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4662
4663@noindent
4664Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
4665static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
4666make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
4667to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
4668
474c8240 4669@smallexample
c906108c 4670(@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
474c8240 4671@end smallexample
c906108c 4672
b37052ae 4673@cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
c906108c 4674This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
b37052ae 4675use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
4676scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
4677@c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
4678@c conflict?? --mew
c906108c
SS
4679
4680@cindex wrong values
4681@cindex variable values, wrong
4682@quotation
4683@emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
4684wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
4685scope, and just before exit.
4686@end quotation
4687You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
4688This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
4689set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
4690stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
4691values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
4692also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
4693after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
4694variable definitions may be gone.
4695
4696This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
4697To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
4698when compiling.
4699
d4f3574e
SS
4700@cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
4701Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
4702unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
4703opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
4704offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
4705might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
4706happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
4707
474c8240 4708@smallexample
d4f3574e 4709No symbol "foo" in current context.
474c8240 4710@end smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
4711
4712To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
4713different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
b37052ae 4714formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler usually
d4f3574e
SS
4715supports the @samp{-gstabs} option. @samp{-gstabs} produces debug info
4716in a format that is superior to formats such as COFF. You may be able
96c405b3 4717to use DWARF2 (@samp{-gdwarf-2}), which is also an effective form for
d4f3574e
SS
4718debug info. See @ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your
4719Program or @sc{gnu} CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more
4720information.
4721
4722
6d2ebf8b 4723@node Arrays
c906108c
SS
4724@section Artificial arrays
4725
4726@cindex artificial array
41afff9a 4727@kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
c906108c
SS
4728It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
4729same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
4730dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
4731program.
4732
4733You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
4734@dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
4735operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
4736and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
4737of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
4738the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
4739argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
4740following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
4741example. If a program says
4742
474c8240 4743@smallexample
c906108c 4744int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
474c8240 4745@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4746
4747@noindent
4748you can print the contents of @code{array} with
4749
474c8240 4750@smallexample
c906108c 4751p *array@@len
474c8240 4752@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4753
4754The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
4755with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
4756subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
4757Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
4758(@pxref{Value History, ,Value history}), after printing one out.
4759
4760Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
4761This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
4762The value need not be in memory:
474c8240 4763@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4764(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
4765$1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
474c8240 4766@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4767
4768As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
c3f6f71d 4769@samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
c906108c 4770the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
474c8240 4771@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4772(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
4773$2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
474c8240 4774@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4775
4776Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
4777moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
4778actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
4779of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
4780to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4781variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
4782interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
4783instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
4784structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
4785in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
4786
474c8240 4787@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4788set $i = 0
4789p dtab[$i++]->fv
4790@key{RET}
4791@key{RET}
4792@dots{}
474c8240 4793@end smallexample
c906108c 4794
6d2ebf8b 4795@node Output Formats
c906108c
SS
4796@section Output formats
4797
4798@cindex formatted output
4799@cindex output formats
4800By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
4801this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
4802in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
4803at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
4804these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
4805
4806The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
4807already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
4808@code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
4809letters supported are:
4810
4811@table @code
4812@item x
4813Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
4814hexadecimal.
4815
4816@item d
4817Print as integer in signed decimal.
4818
4819@item u
4820Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
4821
4822@item o
4823Print as integer in octal.
4824
4825@item t
4826Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
4827@footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
4828used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
d4f3574e 4829see @ref{Memory,,Examining memory}.}
c906108c
SS
4830
4831@item a
4832@cindex unknown address, locating
3d67e040 4833@cindex locate address
c906108c
SS
4834Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
4835the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
4836where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
4837
474c8240 4838@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4839(@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
4840$3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
474c8240 4841@end smallexample
c906108c 4842
3d67e040
EZ
4843@noindent
4844The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
4845@xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
4846
c906108c
SS
4847@item c
4848Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant.
4849
4850@item f
4851Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
4852using typical floating point syntax.
4853@end table
4854
4855For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
4856
474c8240 4857@smallexample
c906108c 4858p/x $pc
474c8240 4859@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4860
4861@noindent
4862Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
4863names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
4864
4865To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
4866you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
4867expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
4868
6d2ebf8b 4869@node Memory
c906108c
SS
4870@section Examining memory
4871
4872You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
4873any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
4874
4875@cindex examining memory
4876@table @code
41afff9a 4877@kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
c906108c
SS
4878@item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
4879@itemx x @var{addr}
4880@itemx x
4881Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
4882@end table
4883
4884@var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
4885much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
4886expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
4887If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
4888Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
4889
4890@table @r
4891@item @var{n}, the repeat count
4892The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
4893how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
4894@c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
4895@c 4.1.2.
4896
4897@item @var{f}, the display format
4898The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print},
4899@samp{s} (null-terminated string), or @samp{i} (machine instruction).
4900The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially.
4901The default changes each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
4902
4903@item @var{u}, the unit size
4904The unit size is any of
4905
4906@table @code
4907@item b
4908Bytes.
4909@item h
4910Halfwords (two bytes).
4911@item w
4912Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
4913@item g
4914Giant words (eight bytes).
4915@end table
4916
4917Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
4918default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
4919@samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
4920
4921@item @var{addr}, starting display address
4922@var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
4923memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
4924it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
4925@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
4926@var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
4927other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
4928the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
4929starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
4930a value from memory).
4931@end table
4932
4933For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
4934(@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
4935starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
4936words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
d4f3574e 4937@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
c906108c
SS
4938
4939Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
4940letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
4941unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
4942specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
4943(However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
4944
4945Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
4946and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
4947@samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
4948including any operands. The command @code{disassemble} gives an
d4f3574e 4949alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
c906108c
SS
4950Code,,Source and machine code}.
4951
4952All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
4953easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
4954you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
4955instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
4956with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
4957the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
4958for successive uses of @code{x}.
4959
4960@cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
4961The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
4962in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
4963would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
4964subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
4965@code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
4966examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
4967@code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
4968the convenience variable @code{$__}.
4969
4970If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
4971are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
4972address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
4973
6d2ebf8b 4974@node Auto Display
c906108c
SS
4975@section Automatic display
4976@cindex automatic display
4977@cindex display of expressions
4978
4979If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
4980(to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
4981display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
4982Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
4983to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
4984The automatic display looks like this:
4985
474c8240 4986@smallexample
c906108c
SS
49872: foo = 38
49883: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
474c8240 4989@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4990
4991@noindent
4992This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
4993displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
4994specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
4995whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
4996format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
4997or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
4998supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
4999
5000@table @code
5001@kindex display
d4f3574e
SS
5002@item display @var{expr}
5003Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
c906108c
SS
5004each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
5005
5006@code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
5007
d4f3574e 5008@item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
c906108c 5009For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
d4f3574e 5010count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
c906108c
SS
5011arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
5012@xref{Output Formats,,Output formats}.
5013
5014@item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
5015For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
5016number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
5017be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
5018doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
5019@end table
5020
5021For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
5022instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
d4f3574e 5023is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
5024
5025@table @code
5026@kindex delete display
5027@kindex undisplay
5028@item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
5029@itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5030Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
5031
5032@code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
5033(Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
5034
5035@kindex disable display
5036@item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5037Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
5038item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
5039enabled again later.
5040
5041@kindex enable display
5042@item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5043Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
5044again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
5045
5046@item display
5047Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
5048done when your program stops.
5049
5050@kindex info display
5051@item info display
5052Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
5053automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
5054values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
5055It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
5056because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
5057@end table
5058
5059If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
5060sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
5061expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
5062variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
5063@code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
5064@code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
5065continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
5066there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
5067automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
5068is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
5069
6d2ebf8b 5070@node Print Settings
c906108c
SS
5071@section Print settings
5072
5073@cindex format options
5074@cindex print settings
5075@value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
5076and symbols are printed.
5077
5078@noindent
5079These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
5080
5081@table @code
5082@kindex set print address
5083@item set print address
5084@itemx set print address on
5085@value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
5086traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
5087even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
5088is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
5089@code{set print address on}:
5090
5091@smallexample
5092@group
5093(@value{GDBP}) f
5094#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
5095 at input.c:530
5096530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
5097@end group
5098@end smallexample
5099
5100@item set print address off
5101Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
5102this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
5103
5104@smallexample
5105@group
5106(@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
5107(@value{GDBP}) f
5108#0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
5109530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
5110@end group
5111@end smallexample
5112
5113You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
5114dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
5115@code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
5116all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
5117
5118@kindex show print address
5119@item show print address
5120Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
5121@end table
5122
5123When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
5124closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
5125identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
5126source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
5127@code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
5128you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
5129it prints a symbolic address:
5130
5131@table @code
5132@kindex set print symbol-filename
5133@item set print symbol-filename on
5134Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
5135symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
5136
5137@item set print symbol-filename off
5138Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
5139default.
5140
5141@kindex show print symbol-filename
5142@item show print symbol-filename
5143Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
5144line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
5145@end table
5146
5147Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
5148numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
5149number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
5150
5151Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
5152printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
5153
5154@table @code
5155@kindex set print max-symbolic-offset
5156@item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
5157Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
5158offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
5d161b24 5159@var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
5160to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
5161
5162@kindex show print max-symbolic-offset
5163@item show print max-symbolic-offset
5164Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
5165symbolic address.
5166@end table
5167
5168@cindex wild pointer, interpreting
5169@cindex pointer, finding referent
5170If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
5171@samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
5172and source file location of the variable where it points, using
5173@samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
5174For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
5175at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
5176
474c8240 5177@smallexample
c906108c
SS
5178(@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
5179(@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
5180$4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
474c8240 5181@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5182
5183@quotation
5184@emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
5185does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
5186the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
5187@end quotation
5188
5189Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
5190
5191@table @code
5192@kindex set print array
5193@item set print array
5194@itemx set print array on
5195Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
5196but uses more space. The default is off.
5197
5198@item set print array off
5199Return to compressed format for arrays.
5200
5201@kindex show print array
5202@item show print array
5203Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
5204arrays.
5205
5206@kindex set print elements
5207@item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
5208Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
5209If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
5210printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
5211This limit also applies to the display of strings.
d4f3574e 5212When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
c906108c
SS
5213Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
5214
5215@kindex show print elements
5216@item show print elements
5217Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
5218If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
5219
5220@kindex set print null-stop
5221@item set print null-stop
5222Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
d4f3574e 5223@sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
c906108c 5224contain only short strings.
d4f3574e 5225The default is off.
c906108c
SS
5226
5227@kindex set print pretty
5228@item set print pretty on
5d161b24 5229Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
c906108c
SS
5230per line, like this:
5231
5232@smallexample
5233@group
5234$1 = @{
5235 next = 0x0,
5236 flags = @{
5237 sweet = 1,
5238 sour = 1
5239 @},
5240 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
5241@}
5242@end group
5243@end smallexample
5244
5245@item set print pretty off
5246Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
5247
5248@smallexample
5249@group
5250$1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
5251meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
5252@end group
5253@end smallexample
5254
5255@noindent
5256This is the default format.
5257
5258@kindex show print pretty
5259@item show print pretty
5260Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
5261
5262@kindex set print sevenbit-strings
5263@item set print sevenbit-strings on
5264Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
5265@value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
5266character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
5267best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
5268high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
5269
5270@item set print sevenbit-strings off
5271Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
5272international character sets, and is the default.
5273
5274@kindex show print sevenbit-strings
5275@item show print sevenbit-strings
5276Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
5277
5278@kindex set print union
5279@item set print union on
5d161b24 5280Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures. This
c906108c
SS
5281is the default setting.
5282
5283@item set print union off
5284Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in structures.
5285
5286@kindex show print union
5287@item show print union
5288Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
5289structures.
5290
5291For example, given the declarations
5292
5293@smallexample
5294typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
5295typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
5d161b24 5296typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
c906108c
SS
5297 Bug_forms;
5298
5299struct thing @{
5300 Species it;
5301 union @{
5302 Tree_forms tree;
5303 Bug_forms bug;
5304 @} form;
5305@};
5306
5307struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
5308@end smallexample
5309
5310@noindent
5311with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
5312
5313@smallexample
5314$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
5315@end smallexample
5316
5317@noindent
5318and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
5319
5320@smallexample
5321$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
5322@end smallexample
5323@end table
5324
c906108c
SS
5325@need 1000
5326@noindent
b37052ae 5327These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
c906108c
SS
5328
5329@table @code
5330@cindex demangling
5331@kindex set print demangle
5332@item set print demangle
5333@itemx set print demangle on
b37052ae 5334Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
c906108c 5335(``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
d4f3574e 5336linkage. The default is on.
c906108c
SS
5337
5338@kindex show print demangle
5339@item show print demangle
b37052ae 5340Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
c906108c
SS
5341
5342@kindex set print asm-demangle
5343@item set print asm-demangle
5344@itemx set print asm-demangle on
b37052ae 5345Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
c906108c
SS
5346in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
5347The default is off.
5348
5349@kindex show print asm-demangle
5350@item show print asm-demangle
b37052ae 5351Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
c906108c
SS
5352or demangled form.
5353
5354@kindex set demangle-style
b37052ae
EZ
5355@cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
5356@cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
5357@item set demangle-style @var{style}
5358Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
b37052ae 5359represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
c906108c
SS
5360
5361@table @code
5362@item auto
5363Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
5364
5365@item gnu
b37052ae 5366Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c 5367This is the default.
c906108c
SS
5368
5369@item hp
b37052ae 5370Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c
SS
5371
5372@item lucid
b37052ae 5373Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c
SS
5374
5375@item arm
b37052ae 5376Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
c906108c
SS
5377@strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
5378debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
5379require further enhancement to permit that.
5380
5381@end table
5382If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
5383
5384@kindex show demangle-style
5385@item show demangle-style
b37052ae 5386Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
c906108c
SS
5387
5388@kindex set print object
5389@item set print object
5390@itemx set print object on
5391When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
5392(derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
5393the virtual function table.
5394
5395@item set print object off
5396Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
5397virtual function table. This is the default setting.
5398
5399@kindex show print object
5400@item show print object
5401Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
5402
5403@kindex set print static-members
5404@item set print static-members
5405@itemx set print static-members on
b37052ae 5406Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
c906108c
SS
5407
5408@item set print static-members off
b37052ae 5409Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
c906108c
SS
5410
5411@kindex show print static-members
5412@item show print static-members
b37052ae 5413Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed, or not.
c906108c
SS
5414
5415@c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
5416@kindex set print vtbl
5417@item set print vtbl
5418@itemx set print vtbl on
b37052ae 5419Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
c906108c 5420(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
b37052ae 5421ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
c906108c
SS
5422
5423@item set print vtbl off
b37052ae 5424Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
c906108c
SS
5425
5426@kindex show print vtbl
5427@item show print vtbl
b37052ae 5428Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
c906108c 5429@end table
c906108c 5430
6d2ebf8b 5431@node Value History
c906108c
SS
5432@section Value history
5433
5434@cindex value history
5d161b24
DB
5435Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
5436@dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
5437Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
5438(for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
5439When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
5440since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
c906108c
SS
5441symbol table.
5442
5443@cindex @code{$}
5444@cindex @code{$$}
5445@cindex history number
5446The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
5447refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
5448@code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
5449printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
5450history number.
5451
5452To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
5453history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
5454remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
5455the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
5456@code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
5457is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
5458@code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
5459
5460For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
5461want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
5462
474c8240 5463@smallexample
c906108c 5464p *$
474c8240 5465@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5466
5467If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
5468to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
5469
474c8240 5470@smallexample
c906108c 5471p *$.next
474c8240 5472@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5473
5474@noindent
5475You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
5476command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
5477
5478Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
5479@code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
5480
474c8240 5481@smallexample
c906108c
SS
5482print x
5483set x=5
474c8240 5484@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5485
5486@noindent
5487then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
5488remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
5489
5490@table @code
5491@kindex show values
5492@item show values
5493Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
5494This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
5495values} does not change the history.
5496
5497@item show values @var{n}
5498Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
5499
5500@item show values +
5501Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
5502values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
5503@end table
5504
5505Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
5506same effect as @samp{show values +}.
5507
6d2ebf8b 5508@node Convenience Vars
c906108c
SS
5509@section Convenience variables
5510
5511@cindex convenience variables
5512@value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
5513@value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
5514exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
5515setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
5516of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
5517
5518Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
5519@samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
d4f3574e 5520the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
5521(Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
5522by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value history}.)
5523
5524You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
5525expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
5526For example:
5527
474c8240 5528@smallexample
c906108c 5529set $foo = *object_ptr
474c8240 5530@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5531
5532@noindent
5533would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
5534@code{object_ptr}.
5535
5536Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
5537value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
5538value with another assignment at any time.
5539
5540Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
5541variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
5542that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
5543variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
5544
5545@table @code
5546@kindex show convenience
5547@item show convenience
5548Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
d4f3574e 5549Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
c906108c
SS
5550@end table
5551
5552One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
5553incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
5554a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
5555
474c8240 5556@smallexample
c906108c
SS
5557set $i = 0
5558print bar[$i++]->contents
474c8240 5559@end smallexample
c906108c 5560
d4f3574e
SS
5561@noindent
5562Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
c906108c
SS
5563
5564Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
5565values likely to be useful.
5566
5567@table @code
41afff9a 5568@vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5569@item $_
5570The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
5571the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}). Other
5572commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
5573set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
5574and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
5575except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
5576to the type of @code{$__}.
5577
41afff9a 5578@vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5579@item $__
5580The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
5581to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
5582to match the format in which the data was printed.
5583
5584@item $_exitcode
41afff9a 5585@vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5586The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
5587the program being debugged terminates.
5588@end table
5589
53a5351d
JM
5590On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
5591begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
5592name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
c906108c 5593
6d2ebf8b 5594@node Registers
c906108c
SS
5595@section Registers
5596
5597@cindex registers
5598You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
5599with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
5600for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
5601your machine.
5602
5603@table @code
5604@kindex info registers
5605@item info registers
5606Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
c85508ee 5607and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
c906108c
SS
5608
5609@kindex info all-registers
5610@cindex floating point registers
5611@item info all-registers
5612Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
c85508ee 5613and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
c906108c
SS
5614
5615@item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
5616Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
5d161b24
DB
5617As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
5618the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
c906108c
SS
5619the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
5620@end table
5621
5622@value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
5623expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
5624architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
5625@code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
5626the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
5627pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
5628register that contains the processor status. For example,
5629you could print the program counter in hex with
5630
474c8240 5631@smallexample
c906108c 5632p/x $pc
474c8240 5633@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5634
5635@noindent
5636or print the instruction to be executed next with
5637
474c8240 5638@smallexample
c906108c 5639x/i $pc
474c8240 5640@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5641
5642@noindent
5643or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
5644one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
5645memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
5646stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
5647stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
5648regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
d4f3574e 5649see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}.} with
c906108c 5650
474c8240 5651@smallexample
c906108c 5652set $sp += 4
474c8240 5653@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5654
5655Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
5656your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
5657so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
5658shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
5659registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
d4f3574e
SS
5660can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
5661is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
c906108c
SS
5662
5663@value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
5664integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
5665special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
5666registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
5667to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
5668(although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
5669@samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
5670
5671Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
5672means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
5673the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
5674sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
5675coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
5676programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
5d161b24 5677cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
c906108c
SS
5678that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
5679prints the data in both formats.
5680
5681Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
5682(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). This means that you get the
5683value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
5684were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
5685true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
5686frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
5687
5688However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
5689code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
5690@value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
5691frame makes no difference.
5692
6d2ebf8b 5693@node Floating Point Hardware
c906108c
SS
5694@section Floating point hardware
5695@cindex floating point
5696
5697Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
5698you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
5699
5700@table @code
5701@kindex info float
5702@item info float
5703Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
5704point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
5705floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
5706the ARM and x86 machines.
5707@end table
c906108c 5708
e76f1f2e
AC
5709@node Vector Unit
5710@section Vector Unit
5711@cindex vector unit
5712
5713Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
5714more information about the status of the vector unit.
5715
5716@table @code
5717@kindex info vector
5718@item info vector
5719Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
5720layout vary depending on the hardware.
5721@end table
5722
29e57380 5723@node Memory Region Attributes
16d9dec6 5724@section Memory region attributes
29e57380
C
5725@cindex memory region attributes
5726
5727@dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
5728required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses attributes
5729to determine whether to allow certain types of memory accesses; whether to
5730use specific width accesses; and whether to cache target memory.
5731
5732Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
5733memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
5734accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
5735been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
5736all memory.
5737
5738When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
5739to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
5740
5741@table @code
5742@kindex mem
bfac230e
DH
5743@item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
5744Define memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
5745attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a
5746special case: it is treated as the the target's maximum memory address.
5747(0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
29e57380
C
5748
5749@kindex delete mem
5750@item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
59649f2e 5751Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
29e57380
C
5752
5753@kindex disable mem
5754@item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
59649f2e 5755Disable memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
29e57380
C
5756A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
5757It may be enabled again later.
5758
5759@kindex enable mem
5760@item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
59649f2e 5761Enable memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
29e57380
C
5762
5763@kindex info mem
5764@item info mem
5765Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
5766for each region.
5767
5768@table @emph
5769@item Memory Region Number
5770@item Enabled or Disabled.
5771Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
5772Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
5773
5774@item Lo Address
5775The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
5776
5777@item Hi Address
5778The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
5779
5780@item Attributes
5781The list of attributes set for this memory region.
5782@end table
5783@end table
5784
5785
5786@subsection Attributes
5787
5788@subsubsection Memory Access Mode
5789The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
5790write accesses to a memory region.
5791
5792While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
5793memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
5794etc. from accessing memory.
5795
5796@table @code
5797@item ro
5798Memory is read only.
5799@item wo
5800Memory is write only.
5801@item rw
6ca652b0 5802Memory is read/write. This is the default.
29e57380
C
5803@end table
5804
5805@subsubsection Memory Access Size
5806The acccess size attributes tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
5807accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
5808require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
5809specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
5810
5811@table @code
5812@item 8
5813Use 8 bit memory accesses.
5814@item 16
5815Use 16 bit memory accesses.
5816@item 32
5817Use 32 bit memory accesses.
5818@item 64
5819Use 64 bit memory accesses.
5820@end table
5821
5822@c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
5823@c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5824@c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
5825@c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
5826@c
5827@c @table @code
5828@c @item hwbreak
5829@c Always use hardware breakpoints
5830@c @item swbreak (default)
5831@c @end table
5832
5833@subsubsection Data Cache
5834The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
5835memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
5836protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
5837does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
5838registers.
5839
5840@table @code
5841@item cache
5842Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
6ca652b0
EZ
5843@item nocache
5844Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
29e57380
C
5845@end table
5846
5847@c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
5848@c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5849@c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
5850@c
5851@c @table @code
5852@c @item verify
5853@c @item noverify (default)
5854@c @end table
5855
16d9dec6
MS
5856@node Dump/Restore Files
5857@section Copy between memory and a file
5858@cindex dump/restore files
5859@cindex append data to a file
5860@cindex dump data to a file
5861@cindex restore data from a file
5862@kindex dump
5863@kindex append
5864@kindex restore
5865
5866The commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and @code{restore} are used
5867for copying data between target memory and a file. Data is written
5868into a file using @code{dump} or @code{append}, and restored from a
5869file into memory by using @code{restore}. Files may be binary, srec,
5870intel hex, or tekhex (but only binary files can be appended).
5871
5872@table @code
5873@kindex dump binary
5874@kindex append binary
5875@item dump binary memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5876Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5877raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5878
5879@item append binary memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5880Append contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} to
5881raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5882
5883@item dump binary value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5884Dump value of @var{expression} into raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5885
5886@item append binary memory @var{filename} @var{expression}
5887Append value of @var{expression} to raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5888
5889@kindex dump ihex
5890@item dump ihex memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5891Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5892intel hex format file @var{filename}.
5893
5894@item dump ihex value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5895Dump value of @var{expression} into intel hex format file @var{filename}.
5896
5897@kindex dump srec
5898@item dump srec memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5899Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5900srec format file @var{filename}.
5901
5902@item dump srec value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5903Dump value of @var{expression} into srec format file @var{filename}.
5904
5905@kindex dump tekhex
5906@item dump tekhex memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5907Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5908tekhex format file @var{filename}.
5909
5910@item dump tekhex value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5911Dump value of @var{expression} into tekhex format file @var{filename}.
5912
42f9b0a5 5913@item restore @var{filename} [@var{binary}] @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
16d9dec6
MS
5914Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The @code{restore}
5915command can automatically recognize any known bfd file format, except for
5916raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you must use the optional argument
5917@var{binary} after the filename.
5918
5919If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
5920contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
5921they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
5922a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
5923from that location.
5924
5925If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
5926file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
5927These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
5928the @var{bias} argument is applied.
5929
5930@end table
5931
a0eb71c5
KB
5932@node Character Sets
5933@section Character Sets
5934@cindex character sets
5935@cindex charset
5936@cindex translating between character sets
5937@cindex host character set
5938@cindex target character set
5939
5940If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
5941represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
5942@value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
5943you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
5944character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
5945@dfn{target character set}.
5946
5947For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
5948uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
5949remote protocol (@pxref{Remote,Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
5950running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
5951then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
5952@sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
5953target-charset ebcdic-us}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
5954@sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
5955character and string literals in expressions.
5956
5957@value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
5958the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
5959target-charset} command, described below.
5960
5961Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
5962support:
5963
5964@table @code
5965@item set target-charset @var{charset}
5966@kindex set target-charset
5967Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. We list the
5968character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, but if you invoke the
5969@code{set target-charset} command with no argument, @value{GDBN} lists
5970the character sets it supports.
5971@end table
5972
5973@table @code
5974@item set host-charset @var{charset}
5975@kindex set host-charset
5976Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
5977
5978By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
5979system it is running on; you can override that default using the
5980@code{set host-charset} command.
5981
5982@value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
5983set. We list the character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, and
5984indicate which can be host character sets, but if you invoke the
5985@code{set host-charset} command with no argument, @value{GDBN} lists the
5986character sets it supports, placing an asterisk (@samp{*}) after those
5987it can use as a host character set.
5988
5989@item set charset @var{charset}
5990@kindex set charset
5991Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. If you
5992invoke the @code{set charset} command with no argument, it lists the
5993character sets it supports. @value{GDBN} can only use certain character
5994sets as its host character set; it marks those in the list with an
5995asterisk (@samp{*}).
5996
5997@item show charset
5998@itemx show host-charset
5999@itemx show target-charset
6000@kindex show charset
6001@kindex show host-charset
6002@kindex show target-charset
6003Show the current host and target charsets. The @code{show host-charset}
6004and @code{show target-charset} commands are synonyms for @code{show
6005charset}.
6006
6007@end table
6008
6009@value{GDBN} currently includes support for the following character
6010sets:
6011
6012@table @code
6013
6014@item ASCII
6015@cindex ASCII character set
6016Seven-bit U.S. @sc{ascii}. @value{GDBN} can use this as its host
6017character set.
6018
6019@item ISO-8859-1
6020@cindex ISO 8859-1 character set
6021@cindex ISO Latin 1 character set
6022The ISO Latin 1 character set. This extends ASCII with accented
6023characters needed for French, German, and Spanish. @value{GDBN} can use
6024this as its host character set.
6025
6026@item EBCDIC-US
6027@itemx IBM1047
6028@cindex EBCDIC character set
6029@cindex IBM1047 character set
6030Variants of the @sc{ebcdic} character set, used on some of IBM's
6031mainframe operating systems. (@sc{gnu}/Linux on the S/390 uses U.S. @sc{ascii}.)
6032@value{GDBN} cannot use these as its host character set.
6033
6034@end table
6035
6036Note that these are all single-byte character sets. More work inside
6037GDB is needed to support multi-byte or variable-width character
6038encodings, like the UTF-8 and UCS-2 encodings of Unicode.
6039
6040Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
6041Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
6042@file{charset-test.c}:
6043
6044@smallexample
6045#include <stdio.h>
6046
6047char ascii_hello[]
6048 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
6049 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
6050char ibm1047_hello[]
6051 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
6052 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
6053
6054main ()
6055@{
6056 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6057@}
10998722 6058@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6059
6060In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
6061containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
6062encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
6063
6064We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
6065
6066@smallexample
6067$ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
6068$ gdb -nw charset-test
6069GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
6070Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6071@dots{}
6072(gdb)
10998722 6073@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6074
6075We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
6076@value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
6077strings:
6078
6079@smallexample
6080(gdb) show charset
6081The current host and target character set is `iso-8859-1'.
6082(gdb)
10998722 6083@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6084
6085For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
6086initial character set:
6087@smallexample
6088(gdb) set charset ascii
6089(gdb) show charset
6090The current host and target character set is `ascii'.
6091(gdb)
10998722 6092@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6093
6094Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
6095host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
6096characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
6097them properly. Since our current target character set is also
6098@sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
6099
6100@smallexample
6101(gdb) print ascii_hello
6102$1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
6103(gdb) print ascii_hello[0]
6104$2 = 72 'H'
6105(gdb)
10998722 6106@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6107
6108@value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
6109literals you use in expressions:
6110
6111@smallexample
6112(gdb) print '+'
6113$3 = 43 '+'
6114(gdb)
10998722 6115@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6116
6117The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
6118character.
6119
6120@value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
6121target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
6122character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
6123
6124@smallexample
6125(gdb) print ibm1047_hello
6126$4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
6127(gdb) print ibm1047_hello[0]
6128$5 = 200 '\310'
6129(gdb)
10998722 6130@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6131
6132If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} command without an argument,
6133@value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
6134
6135@smallexample
6136(gdb) set target-charset
6137Valid character sets are:
6138 ascii *
6139 iso-8859-1 *
6140 ebcdic-us
6141 ibm1047
6142* - can be used as a host character set
10998722 6143@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6144
6145We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
6146program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
6147@value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
6148target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
6149@sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
6150
6151@smallexample
6152(gdb) set target-charset ibm1047
6153(gdb) show charset
6154The current host character set is `ascii'.
6155The current target character set is `ibm1047'.
6156(gdb) print ascii_hello
6157$6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
6158(gdb) print ascii_hello[0]
6159$7 = 72 '\110'
6160(gdb) print ibm1047_hello
6161$8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
6162(gdb) print ibm1047_hello[0]
6163$9 = 200 'H'
6164(gdb)
10998722 6165@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6166
6167As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
6168string literals you use in expressions:
6169
6170@smallexample
6171(gdb) print '+'
6172$10 = 78 '+'
6173(gdb)
10998722 6174@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6175
6176The IBM1047 character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
6177character.
6178
6179
e2e0bcd1
JB
6180@node Macros
6181@chapter C Preprocessor Macros
6182
6183Some languages, such as C and C++, provide a way to define and invoke
6184``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
6185@value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
6186the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
6187where it was defined.
6188
6189You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
6190with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
6191include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
6192with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
6193
6194A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
6195and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
6196points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
6197no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
6198uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
6199@value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
6200see @ref{List}.
6201
6202At the moment, @value{GDBN} does not support the @code{##}
6203token-splicing operator, the @code{#} stringification operator, or
6204variable-arity macros.
6205
6206Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
6207macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
6208the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
6209
6210@table @code
6211
6212@kindex macro expand
6213@cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
6214@cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
6215@cindex expanding preprocessor macros
6216@item macro expand @var{expression}
6217@itemx macro exp @var{expression}
6218Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
6219@var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
6220not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
6221it can be any string of tokens.
6222
6223@kindex macro expand-once
6224@item macro expand-once @var{expression}
6225@itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
6226@i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
6227expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
6228@var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
6229left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
6230particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
6231expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
6232parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
6233can be any string of tokens.
6234
475b0867 6235@kindex info macro
e2e0bcd1
JB
6236@cindex macro definition, showing
6237@cindex definition, showing a macro's
475b0867 6238@item info macro @var{macro}
e2e0bcd1
JB
6239Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
6240source location where that definition was established.
6241
6242@kindex macro define
6243@cindex user-defined macros
6244@cindex defining macros interactively
6245@cindex macros, user-defined
6246@item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
6247@itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
6248@i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Introduce a definition for a
6249preprocessor macro named @var{macro}, invocations of which are replaced
6250by the tokens given in @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this
6251command defines an ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the
6252second form defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments
6253given in @var{arglist}.
6254
6255A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every expression
6256evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the @command{macro
6257undef} command, described below. The definition overrides all
6258definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged, as
6259well as any previous user-supplied definition.
6260
6261@kindex macro undef
6262@item macro undef @var{macro}
6263@i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Remove any user-supplied
6264definition for the macro named @var{macro}. This command only affects
6265definitions provided with the @command{macro define} command, described
6266above; it cannot remove definitions present in the program being
6267debugged.
6268
6269@end table
6270
6271@cindex macros, example of debugging with
6272Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
6273show our source files:
6274
6275@smallexample
6276$ cat sample.c
6277#include <stdio.h>
6278#include "sample.h"
6279
6280#define M 42
6281#define ADD(x) (M + x)
6282
6283main ()
6284@{
6285#define N 28
6286 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6287#undef N
6288 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
6289#define N 1729
6290 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
6291@}
6292$ cat sample.h
6293#define Q <
6294$
6295@end smallexample
6296
6297Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
6298We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
6299compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
6300information.
6301
6302@smallexample
6303$ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
6304$
6305@end smallexample
6306
6307Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
6308
6309@smallexample
6310$ gdb -nw sample
6311GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
6312Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6313GDB is free software, @dots{}
6314(gdb)
6315@end smallexample
6316
6317We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
6318program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
6319to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
6320
6321@smallexample
6322(gdb) list main
63233
63244 #define M 42
63255 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
63266
63277 main ()
63288 @{
63299 #define N 28
633010 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
633111 #undef N
633212 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
475b0867 6333(gdb) info macro ADD
e2e0bcd1
JB
6334Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
6335#define ADD(x) (M + x)
475b0867 6336(gdb) info macro Q
e2e0bcd1
JB
6337Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
6338 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
6339#define Q <
6340(gdb) macro expand ADD(1)
6341expands to: (42 + 1)
6342(gdb) macro expand-once ADD(1)
6343expands to: once (M + 1)
6344(gdb)
6345@end smallexample
6346
6347In the example above, note that @command{macro expand-once} expands only
6348the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
6349@code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
6350which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
6351
6352Once the program is running, GDB uses the macro definitions in force at
6353the source line of the current stack frame:
6354
6355@smallexample
6356(gdb) break main
6357Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
6358(gdb) run
6359Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
6360
6361Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
636210 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6363(gdb)
6364@end smallexample
6365
6366At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
6367
6368@smallexample
475b0867 6369(gdb) info macro N
e2e0bcd1
JB
6370Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
6371#define N 28
6372(gdb) macro expand N Q M
6373expands to: 28 < 42
6374(gdb) print N Q M
6375$1 = 1
6376(gdb)
6377@end smallexample
6378
6379As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
6380give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
6381thereof) in force at each point:
6382
6383@smallexample
6384(gdb) next
6385Hello, world!
638612 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
475b0867 6387(gdb) info macro N
e2e0bcd1
JB
6388The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
6389at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
6390(gdb) next
6391We're so creative.
639214 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
475b0867 6393(gdb) info macro N
e2e0bcd1
JB
6394Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
6395#define N 1729
6396(gdb) macro expand N Q M
6397expands to: 1729 < 42
6398(gdb) print N Q M
6399$2 = 0
6400(gdb)
6401@end smallexample
6402
6403
b37052ae
EZ
6404@node Tracepoints
6405@chapter Tracepoints
6406@c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
6407@c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
6408
6409@cindex tracepoints
6410In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
6411the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
6412anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
6413depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
6414might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
6415fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
6416to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
6417
6418Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
6419specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
6420arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
6421Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
6422those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
6423expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
6424for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
6425a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
6426in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
6427values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
6428unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
6429
6430The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
2c0069bb
EZ
6431targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know how
6432to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the remote
6433stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN} support
6434tracepoints as of this writing.
b37052ae
EZ
6435
6436This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
6437
6438@menu
6439* Set Tracepoints::
6440* Analyze Collected Data::
6441* Tracepoint Variables::
6442@end menu
6443
6444@node Set Tracepoints
6445@section Commands to Set Tracepoints
6446
6447Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
6448tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
6449tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
6450breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
6451one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
6452tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
6453work on.
6454
6455For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
6456of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
6457it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
6458local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
6459commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
6460tracepoint was hit.
6461
6462This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
6463conditions and actions.
6464
6465@menu
6466* Create and Delete Tracepoints::
6467* Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
6468* Tracepoint Passcounts::
6469* Tracepoint Actions::
6470* Listing Tracepoints::
6471* Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment::
6472@end menu
6473
6474@node Create and Delete Tracepoints
6475@subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
6476
6477@table @code
6478@cindex set tracepoint
6479@kindex trace
6480@item trace
6481The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
6482Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
6483the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
6484defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
6485debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
6486program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
6487doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
6488cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
6489running.
6490
6491Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
6492
6493@smallexample
6494(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
6495
6496(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
6497
6498(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
6499
6500(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
6501
6502(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
6503@end smallexample
6504
6505@noindent
6506You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
6507
6508@vindex $tpnum
6509@cindex last tracepoint number
6510@cindex recent tracepoint number
6511@cindex tracepoint number
6512The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
6513of the most recently set tracepoint.
6514
6515@kindex delete tracepoint
6516@cindex tracepoint deletion
6517@item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6518Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
6519default is to delete all tracepoints.
6520
6521Examples:
6522
6523@smallexample
6524(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
6525
6526(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
6527@end smallexample
6528
6529@noindent
6530You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
6531@end table
6532
6533@node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
6534@subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
6535
6536@table @code
6537@kindex disable tracepoint
6538@item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6539Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
6540@var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
6541the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
6542a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
6543
6544@kindex enable tracepoint
6545@item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6546Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
6547tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
6548run.
6549@end table
6550
6551@node Tracepoint Passcounts
6552@subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
6553
6554@table @code
6555@kindex passcount
6556@cindex tracepoint pass count
6557@item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
6558Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
6559automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
6560@var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
6561the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
6562@var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
6563passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
6564given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
6565user.
6566
6567Examples:
6568
6569@smallexample
6826cf00
EZ
6570(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
6571@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
b37052ae
EZ
6572
6573(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
6826cf00 6574@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
b37052ae
EZ
6575(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
6576(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
6577(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
6578(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
6579(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
6580(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
6826cf00
EZ
6581@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
6582@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
6583@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
b37052ae
EZ
6584@end smallexample
6585@end table
6586
6587@node Tracepoint Actions
6588@subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
6589
6590@table @code
6591@kindex actions
6592@cindex tracepoint actions
6593@item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6594This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
6595tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
6596specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
6597recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
6598@code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
6599actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
6600terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
6601far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
6602@code{while-stepping}.
6603
6604@cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
6605To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
6606and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
6607
6608@smallexample
6609(@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
6610
6826cf00 6611(@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
b37052ae 6612
6826cf00 6613(@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
b37052ae
EZ
6614@end smallexample
6615
6616In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
6617commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
6618hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
6619following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
6620followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
6621@code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
6622@code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
6623@code{end} command.
6624
6625@smallexample
6626(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
6627(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6628Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
6629> collect bar,baz
6630> collect $regs
6631> while-stepping 12
6632 > collect $fp, $sp
6633 > end
6634end
6635@end smallexample
6636
6637@kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
6638@item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
6639Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
6640This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
6641In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
6642special arguments are supported:
6643
6644@table @code
6645@item $regs
6646collect all registers
6647
6648@item $args
6649collect all function arguments
6650
6651@item $locals
6652collect all local variables.
6653@end table
6654
6655You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
6656with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
6657arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
6658
f5c37c66
EZ
6659The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
6660particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
6661
b37052ae
EZ
6662@kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
6663@item while-stepping @var{n}
6664Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
6665new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
6666followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
6667its own @code{end} command):
6668
6669@smallexample
6670> while-stepping 12
6671 > collect $regs, myglobal
6672 > end
6673>
6674@end smallexample
6675
6676@noindent
6677You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
6678@code{stepping}.
6679@end table
6680
6681@node Listing Tracepoints
6682@subsection Listing Tracepoints
6683
6684@table @code
6685@kindex info tracepoints
6686@cindex information about tracepoints
6687@item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8a037dd7 6688Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify
798c8bc6 6689a tracepoint number, displays information about all the tracepoints
b37052ae
EZ
6690defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
6691shown:
6692
6693@itemize @bullet
6694@item
6695its number
6696@item
6697whether it is enabled or disabled
6698@item
6699its address
6700@item
6701its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
6702@item
6703its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
6704@item
6705where in the source files is the tracepoint set
6706@item
6707its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
6708@end itemize
6709
6710@smallexample
6711(@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
6712Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
67131 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
6826cf00
EZ
67142 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in g_test at g_test.c:1375
67153 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in get_data at ../foo.c:41
b37052ae
EZ
6716(@value{GDBP})
6717@end smallexample
6718
6719@noindent
6720This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
6721@end table
6722
6723@node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
6724@subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
6725
6726@table @code
6727@kindex tstart
6728@cindex start a new trace experiment
6729@cindex collected data discarded
6730@item tstart
6731This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
6732begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
6733the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
6734experiment.
6735
6736@kindex tstop
6737@cindex stop a running trace experiment
6738@item tstop
6739This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
6740stops collecting data.
6741
6742@strong{Note:} a trace experiment and data collection may stop
6743automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
6744(@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
6745
6746@kindex tstatus
6747@cindex status of trace data collection
6748@cindex trace experiment, status of
6749@item tstatus
6750This command displays the status of the current trace data
6751collection.
6752@end table
6753
6754Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
6755
6756@smallexample
6757(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
6758(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6759Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
6760> collect $regs,$locals,$args
6761> while-stepping 11
6762 > collect $regs
6763 > end
6764> end
6765(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6766 [time passes @dots{}]
6767(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
6768@end smallexample
6769
6770
6771@node Analyze Collected Data
6772@section Using the collected data
6773
6774After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
6775for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
6776collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
6777snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
6778consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
6779examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
6780specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
6781snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
6782registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
6783rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
6784debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
6785(@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
6786behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
6787when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
6788the buffer will fail.
6789
6790@menu
6791* tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
6792* tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
6793* save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
6794@end menu
6795
6796@node tfind
6797@subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
6798
6799@kindex tfind
6800@cindex select trace snapshot
6801@cindex find trace snapshot
6802The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
6803@code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
6804counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
6805snapshot is selected.
6806
6807Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
6808
6809@table @code
6810@item tfind start
6811Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
6812@code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
6813
6814@item tfind none
6815Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
6816
6817@item tfind end
6818Same as @samp{tfind none}.
6819
6820@item tfind
6821No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
6822
6823@item tfind -
6824Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
6825retracing earlier steps.
6826
6827@item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
6828Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
6829proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
6830argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
6831for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
6832
6833@item tfind pc @var{addr}
6834Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
6835program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
6836snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
6837snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
6838
6839@item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6840Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
6841addresses.
6842
6843@item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6844Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
6845@var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
6846
6847@item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
6848Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
6849the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
6850that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
6851trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
6852next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
6853@code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
6854stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
6855@end table
6856
6857The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
6858designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
6859instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
6860snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
6861trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
6862simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
6863snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
6864@key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
6865The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
6866for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
6867no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
6868(PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
6869no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
6870tracepoint as the current one.
6871
6872In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
6873these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
6874scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
6875you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
6876registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
6877
6878@smallexample
6879(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6880(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6881> printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
6882 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
6883> tfind
6884> end
6885
6886Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
6887Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
6888Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
6889Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
6890Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
6891Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
6892Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
6893Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
6894Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
6895Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
6896Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
6897@end smallexample
6898
6899Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
6900the buffer:
6901
6902@smallexample
6903(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6904(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6905> printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
6906> tfind line
6907> end
6908
6909Frame 0, X = 1
6910Frame 7, X = 2
6911Frame 13, X = 255
6912@end smallexample
6913
6914@node tdump
6915@subsection @code{tdump}
6916@kindex tdump
6917@cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
6918@cindex tracepoint data, display
6919
6920This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
6921the current trace snapshot.
6922
6923@smallexample
6924(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
6925(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6926Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
6927> collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
6928> end
6929
6930(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6931
6932(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
6933#0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
6934at gdb_test.c:444
6935444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
6936
6937(@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
6938Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
6939d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
6940d1 0x18 24
6941d2 0x80 128
6942d3 0x33 51
6943d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
6944d5 0x22 34
6945d6 0xe0 224
6946d7 0x380035 3670069
6947a0 0x19e24a 1696330
6948a1 0x3000668 50333288
6949a2 0x100 256
6950a3 0x322000 3284992
6951a4 0x3000698 50333336
6952a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
6953fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
6954sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
6955ps 0x0 0
6956pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
6957fpcontrol 0x0 0
6958fpstatus 0x0 0
6959fpiaddr 0x0 0
6960p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
6961p1 = (void *) 0x11
6962p2 = (void *) 0x22
6963p3 = (void *) 0x33
6964p4 = (void *) 0x44
6965p5 = (void *) 0x55
6966p6 = (void *) 0x66
6967gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
6968
6969(@value{GDBP})
6970@end smallexample
6971
6972@node save-tracepoints
6973@subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
6974@kindex save-tracepoints
6975@cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
6976
6977This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
6978their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
6979suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
6980tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
6981Files}).
6982
6983@node Tracepoint Variables
6984@section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
6985@cindex tracepoint variables
6986@cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
6987
6988@table @code
6989@vindex $trace_frame
6990@item (int) $trace_frame
6991The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
6992snapshot is selected.
6993
6994@vindex $tracepoint
6995@item (int) $tracepoint
6996The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
6997
6998@vindex $trace_line
6999@item (int) $trace_line
7000The line number for the current trace snapshot.
7001
7002@vindex $trace_file
7003@item (char []) $trace_file
7004The source file for the current trace snapshot.
7005
7006@vindex $trace_func
7007@item (char []) $trace_func
7008The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
7009@end table
7010
7011Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
7012use @code{output} instead.
7013
7014Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
7015stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
7016data.
7017
7018@smallexample
7019(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
7020
7021(@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
7022> output $trace_file
7023> printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
7024> tfind
7025> end
7026@end smallexample
7027
df0cd8c5
JB
7028@node Overlays
7029@chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
7030@cindex overlays
7031
7032If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
7033memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
7034problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
7035use overlays.
7036
7037@menu
7038* How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
7039* Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
7040* Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
7041 mapped by asking the inferior.
7042* Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
7043@end menu
7044
7045@node How Overlays Work
7046@section How Overlays Work
7047@cindex mapped overlays
7048@cindex unmapped overlays
7049@cindex load address, overlay's
7050@cindex mapped address
7051@cindex overlay area
7052
7053Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
7054kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
7055other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
7056management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
7057adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
7058
7059One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
7060independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
7061@dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
7062their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
7063instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
7064largest overlay as well.
7065
7066Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
7067overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
7068for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
7069there.
7070
c928edc0
AC
7071@c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
7072@c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
7073@c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
7074
474c8240 7075@smallexample
df0cd8c5 7076@group
c928edc0
AC
7077 Data Instruction Larger
7078Address Space Address Space Address Space
7079+-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
7080| | | | | |
7081+-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
7082| program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
7083| variables | | program | | +-----------+
7084| and heap | | | | | |
7085+-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
7086| | +-----------+ | | | load address
7087+-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
7088 | | | | | |
7089 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
7090 address | | | | | |
7091 | overlay | <-' | | |
7092 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
7093 | | <---. | | load address
7094 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
7095 | | | |
7096 +-----------+ | |
7097 +-----------+
7098 | |
7099 +-----------+
7100
7101 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
df0cd8c5 7102@end group
474c8240 7103@end smallexample
df0cd8c5 7104
c928edc0
AC
7105The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
7106and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
7107its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
7108Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
7109may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
7110data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
7111program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
7112program and the overlay area.
df0cd8c5
JB
7113
7114An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
7115@dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
7116instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
7117in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
7118is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
7119the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
7120called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
7121
7122Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
7123program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
7124global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
7125
7126@itemize @bullet
7127
7128@item
7129Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
7130must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
7131return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
7132overlay, and your program will probably crash.
7133
7134@item
7135If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
7136will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
7137your program's performance.
7138
7139@item
7140The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
7141overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
7142mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
7143and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
7144You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
7145addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
7146ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
7147
7148@item
7149The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
7150to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
7151instruction and data spaces.
7152
7153@end itemize
7154
7155The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
7156improved in many ways:
7157
7158@itemize @bullet
7159
7160@item
7161If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
7162hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
7163contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
7164This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
7165area in the usual way.
7166
7167@item
7168If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
7169overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
7170
7171@item
7172You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
7173general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
7174code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
7175return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
7176the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
7177must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
7178different data overlay into the same mapped area.
7179
7180@end itemize
7181
7182
7183@node Overlay Commands
7184@section Overlay Commands
7185
7186To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
7187correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
7188virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
7189mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
7190@value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
7191variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
7192
7193@value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
7194you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
7195
7196@table @code
7197@item overlay off
7198@kindex overlay off
7199Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
7200disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
7201always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
7202overlay support is disabled.
7203
7204@item overlay manual
7205@kindex overlay manual
7206@cindex manual overlay debugging
7207Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
7208relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
7209using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
7210commands described below.
7211
7212@item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
7213@itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
7214@kindex overlay map-overlay
7215@cindex map an overlay
7216Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
7217be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
7218overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
7219functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
7220that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
7221@var{overlay} are now unmapped.
7222
7223@item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
7224@itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
7225@kindex overlay unmap-overlay
7226@cindex unmap an overlay
7227Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
7228must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
7229When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
7230overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
7231
7232@item overlay auto
7233@kindex overlay auto
7234Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
7235consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
7236to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
7237Overlay Debugging}.
7238
7239@item overlay load-target
7240@itemx overlay load
7241@kindex overlay load-target
7242@cindex reloading the overlay table
7243Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
7244re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
7245stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
7246overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
7247useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
7248
7249@item overlay list-overlays
7250@itemx overlay list
7251@cindex listing mapped overlays
7252Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
7253addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
7254
7255@end table
7256
7257Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
7258of the function the address falls in:
7259
474c8240 7260@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7261(gdb) print main
7262$3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
474c8240 7263@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7264@noindent
7265When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
7266unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
7267asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
7268unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
7269
474c8240 7270@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7271(gdb) overlay list
7272No sections are mapped.
7273(gdb) print foo
7274$5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
474c8240 7275@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7276@noindent
7277When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
7278name normally:
7279
474c8240 7280@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7281(gdb) overlay list
7282Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
7283 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
7284(gdb) print foo
7285$6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
474c8240 7286@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7287
7288When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
7289address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
7290overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
7291@code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
7292code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
7293
7294@itemize @bullet
7295@item
7296@cindex breakpoints in overlays
7297@cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
7298You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
7299@value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
7300@item
7301@value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
7302unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
7303overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
7304you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
7305breakpoints properly.
7306@end itemize
7307
7308
7309@node Automatic Overlay Debugging
7310@section Automatic Overlay Debugging
7311@cindex automatic overlay debugging
7312
7313@value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
7314are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
7315inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
7316@code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
7317looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
7318current state of the overlays.
7319
7320Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
7321@value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
7322
7323@table @asis
7324
7325@item @code{_ovly_table}:
7326This variable must be an array of the following structures:
7327
474c8240 7328@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7329struct
7330@{
7331 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
7332 unsigned long vma;
7333
7334 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
7335 unsigned long size;
7336
7337 /* The overlay's load address. */
7338 unsigned long lma;
7339
7340 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
7341 zero otherwise. */
7342 unsigned long mapped;
7343@}
474c8240 7344@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7345
7346@item @code{_novlys}:
7347This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
7348number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
7349
7350@end table
7351
7352To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
7353looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
7354@code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
7355executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
7356the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
7357currently mapped.
7358
81d46470 7359In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
def71bfa 7360@code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
81d46470
MS
7361will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
7362calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
7363will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
7364are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
7365in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
7366overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
7367are not being executed.
df0cd8c5
JB
7368
7369@node Overlay Sample Program
7370@section Overlay Sample Program
7371@cindex overlay example program
7372
7373When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
7374at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
7375addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
7376Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
7377since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
7378architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
7379portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
7380
7381However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
7382program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
7383suite. The program consists of the following files from
7384@file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
7385
7386@table @file
7387@item overlays.c
7388The main program file.
7389@item ovlymgr.c
7390A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
7391@item foo.c
7392@itemx bar.c
7393@itemx baz.c
7394@itemx grbx.c
7395Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
7396@item d10v.ld
7397@itemx m32r.ld
7398Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
7399and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
7400@end table
7401
7402You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
7403cross-compiler like this:
7404
474c8240 7405@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7406$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
7407$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
7408$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
7409$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
7410$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
7411$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
7412$ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
7413 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
474c8240 7414@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7415
7416The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
7417you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
7418target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
7419
7420
6d2ebf8b 7421@node Languages
c906108c
SS
7422@chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
7423@cindex languages
7424
c906108c
SS
7425Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
7426rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
7427dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
7428Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
5d161b24 7429represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
c906108c 7430@samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
c906108c
SS
7431
7432@cindex working language
7433Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
7434allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
7435native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
7436consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
7437language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
7438language}.
7439
7440@menu
7441* Setting:: Switching between source languages
7442* Show:: Displaying the language
c906108c 7443* Checks:: Type and range checks
c906108c
SS
7444* Support:: Supported languages
7445@end menu
7446
6d2ebf8b 7447@node Setting
c906108c
SS
7448@section Switching between source languages
7449
7450There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
7451set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
7452@code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
7453defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
7454used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
7455are printed, etc.
7456
7457In addition to the working language, every source file that
7458@value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
7459file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
7460source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
7461language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
b37052ae 7462controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
c906108c 7463show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
d4f3574e
SS
7464set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
7465set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
7466Displaying the language}.
c906108c
SS
7467
7468This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
5d161b24 7469as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
c906108c
SS
7470another language. In that case, make the
7471program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
7472@value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
7473program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
7474
7475@menu
7476* Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
7477* Manually:: Setting the working language manually
7478* Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
7479@end menu
7480
6d2ebf8b 7481@node Filenames
c906108c
SS
7482@subsection List of filename extensions and languages
7483
7484If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
7485@value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
7486
7487@table @file
7488
7489@item .c
7490C source file
7491
7492@item .C
7493@itemx .cc
7494@itemx .cp
7495@itemx .cpp
7496@itemx .cxx
7497@itemx .c++
b37052ae 7498C@t{++} source file
c906108c
SS
7499
7500@item .f
7501@itemx .F
7502Fortran source file
7503
c906108c
SS
7504@item .mod
7505Modula-2 source file
c906108c
SS
7506
7507@item .s
7508@itemx .S
7509Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
7510@value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
7511@end table
7512
7513In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
7514extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the language}.
7515
6d2ebf8b 7516@node Manually
c906108c
SS
7517@subsection Setting the working language
7518
7519If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
7520expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
7521your program.
7522
7523@kindex set language
7524If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
7525command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
5d161b24 7526a language, such as
c906108c 7527@code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
c906108c
SS
7528For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
7529
c906108c
SS
7530Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
7531language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
7532to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
7533source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
7534languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
7535source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
7536command such as:
7537
474c8240 7538@smallexample
c906108c 7539print a = b + c
474c8240 7540@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
7541
7542@noindent
7543might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
7544@code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
7545printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
7546@code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
c906108c 7547
6d2ebf8b 7548@node Automatically
c906108c
SS
7549@subsection Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
7550
7551To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
7552@samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
7553then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
7554frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
7555working language to the language recorded for the function in that
7556frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
7557or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
7558does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
7559not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
7560
7561This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
7562entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
7563written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
7564a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
7565case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
7566
6d2ebf8b 7567@node Show
c906108c 7568@section Displaying the language
c906108c
SS
7569
7570The following commands help you find out which language is the
7571working language, and also what language source files were written in.
7572
7573@kindex show language
d4f3574e
SS
7574@kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
7575@kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
c906108c
SS
7576@table @code
7577@item show language
7578Display the current working language. This is the
7579language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
7580build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
7581
7582@item info frame
5d161b24 7583Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
c906108c 7584working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
5d161b24 7585@xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}, to identify the other
c906108c
SS
7586information listed here.
7587
7588@item info source
7589Display the source language of this source file.
5d161b24 7590@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
c906108c
SS
7591information listed here.
7592@end table
7593
7594In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
7595not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
7596with a language explicitly:
7597
7598@kindex set extension-language
7599@kindex info extensions
7600@table @code
7601@item set extension-language @var{.ext} @var{language}
7602Set source files with extension @var{.ext} to be assumed to be in
7603the source language @var{language}.
7604
7605@item info extensions
7606List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
7607@end table
7608
6d2ebf8b 7609@node Checks
c906108c
SS
7610@section Type and range checking
7611
7612@quotation
7613@emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
7614checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
7615section documents the intended facilities.
7616@end quotation
7617@c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
7618
7619Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
7620errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
7621checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
7622sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
7623these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
7624by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
7625errors when your program is running.
7626
7627@value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
7628Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program, it
7629can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via
7630the @code{print} command, for example. As with the working language,
7631@value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check automatically based on
7632your program's source language. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages},
7633for the default settings of supported languages.
7634
7635@menu
7636* Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
7637* Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
7638@end menu
7639
7640@cindex type checking
7641@cindex checks, type
6d2ebf8b 7642@node Type Checking
c906108c
SS
7643@subsection An overview of type checking
7644
7645Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
7646arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
7647otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
7648errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
7649
7650@smallexample
76511 + 2 @result{} 3
7652@exdent but
7653@error{} 1 + 2.3
7654@end smallexample
7655
7656The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
7657type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
7658
5d161b24
DB
7659For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
7660@value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
7661to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
7662or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
c906108c
SS
7663but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
7664these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
7665also issues a warning.
7666
5d161b24
DB
7667Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
7668related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
7669For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
7670a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
7671with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
c906108c
SS
7672the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
7673
7674Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
7675instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
7676operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
7677represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
7678operators. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for further
7679details on specific languages.
7680
7681@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
7682
d4f3574e 7683@kindex set check@r{, type}
c906108c
SS
7684@kindex set check type
7685@kindex show check type
7686@table @code
7687@item set check type auto
7688Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
7689@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
7690each language.
7691
7692@item set check type on
7693@itemx set check type off
7694Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
7695current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
7696match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
d4f3574e 7697evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
c906108c
SS
7698message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
7699
7700@item set check type warn
7701Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
7702evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
7703be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
7704numbers and structures.
7705
7706@item show type
5d161b24 7707Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
7708is setting it automatically.
7709@end table
7710
7711@cindex range checking
7712@cindex checks, range
6d2ebf8b 7713@node Range Checking
c906108c
SS
7714@subsection An overview of range checking
7715
7716In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
7717bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
7718checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
7719computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
7720not exceed the bounds of the array.
7721
7722For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
7723@value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
7724always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
7725warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
7726
7727A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
7728array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
7729of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
7730error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
7731result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
7732the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
7733
474c8240 7734@smallexample
c906108c 7735@var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
474c8240 7736@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
7737
7738This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
7739specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Support, ,
7740Supported languages}, for further details on specific languages.
7741
7742@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
7743
d4f3574e 7744@kindex set check@r{, range}
c906108c
SS
7745@kindex set check range
7746@kindex show check range
7747@table @code
7748@item set check range auto
7749Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
7750@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
7751each language.
7752
7753@item set check range on
7754@itemx set check range off
7755Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
7756current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
c3f6f71d
JM
7757match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
7758then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
c906108c
SS
7759
7760@item set check range warn
7761Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
7762but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
7763expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
7764memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
7765systems).
7766
7767@item show range
7768Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
7769being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
7770@end table
c906108c 7771
6d2ebf8b 7772@node Support
c906108c 7773@section Supported languages
c906108c 7774
e632838e 7775@value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Fortran, Java, assembly, and Modula-2.
cce74817 7776@c This is false ...
c906108c
SS
7777Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
7778language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
7779and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
7780,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
7781language.
7782
7783The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
7784supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
7785tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
7786@value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
7787formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
7788books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
7789language reference or tutorial.
7790
c906108c 7791@menu
b37052ae 7792* C:: C and C@t{++}
cce74817 7793* Modula-2:: Modula-2
c906108c
SS
7794@end menu
7795
6d2ebf8b 7796@node C
b37052ae 7797@subsection C and C@t{++}
7a292a7a 7798
b37052ae
EZ
7799@cindex C and C@t{++}
7800@cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
c906108c 7801
b37052ae 7802Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
c906108c
SS
7803to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
7804together.
7805
41afff9a
EZ
7806@cindex C@t{++}
7807@cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
b37052ae
EZ
7808@cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
7809The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
7810compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
7811effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
7812C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
7813compiler (@code{aCC}).
7814
b37052ae 7815For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the stabs debugging
c906108c
SS
7816format. You can select that format explicitly with the @code{g++}
7817command-line options @samp{-gstabs} or @samp{-gstabs+}. See
7818@ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu}
7819CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more information.
c906108c 7820
c906108c 7821@menu
b37052ae
EZ
7822* C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
7823* C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
7824* C plus plus expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
7825* C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
7826* C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
c906108c 7827* Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
b37052ae 7828* Debugging C plus plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
c906108c 7829@end menu
c906108c 7830
6d2ebf8b 7831@node C Operators
b37052ae 7832@subsubsection C and C@t{++} operators
7a292a7a 7833
b37052ae 7834@cindex C and C@t{++} operators
c906108c
SS
7835
7836Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
7837@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
5d161b24 7838often defined on groups of types.
c906108c 7839
b37052ae 7840For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
c906108c
SS
7841
7842@itemize @bullet
53a5351d 7843
c906108c 7844@item
c906108c 7845@emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
b37052ae 7846specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
c906108c
SS
7847
7848@item
d4f3574e
SS
7849@emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
7850@code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
c906108c
SS
7851
7852@item
53a5351d 7853@emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
c906108c
SS
7854
7855@item
7856@emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
53a5351d 7857
c906108c
SS
7858@end itemize
7859
7860@noindent
7861The following operators are supported. They are listed here
7862in order of increasing precedence:
7863
7864@table @code
7865@item ,
7866The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
7867are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
7868expression being the last expression evaluated.
7869
7870@item =
7871Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
7872assigned. Defined on scalar types.
7873
7874@item @var{op}=
7875Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
7876and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
d4f3574e 7877@w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
c906108c
SS
7878@var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
7879@code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
7880
7881@item ?:
7882The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
7883of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
7884integral type.
7885
7886@item ||
7887Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7888
7889@item &&
7890Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
7891
7892@item |
7893Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7894
7895@item ^
7896Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7897
7898@item &
7899Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
7900
7901@item ==@r{, }!=
7902Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
7903expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
7904
7905@item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
7906Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
7907Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
7908and non-zero for true.
7909
7910@item <<@r{, }>>
7911left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
7912
7913@item @@
7914The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
7915
7916@item +@r{, }-
7917Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
7918pointer types.
7919
7920@item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
7921Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
7922defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
7923integral types.
7924
7925@item ++@r{, }--
7926Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
7927operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
7928when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
7929operation takes place.
7930
7931@item *
7932Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
7933@code{++}.
7934
7935@item &
7936Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
7937
b37052ae
EZ
7938For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
7939allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
c906108c 7940(or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
b37052ae 7941where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
c906108c 7942stored.
c906108c
SS
7943
7944@item -
7945Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
7946precedence as @code{++}.
7947
7948@item !
7949Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
7950@code{++}.
7951
7952@item ~
7953Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
7954@code{++}.
7955
7956
7957@item .@r{, }->
7958Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
7959@value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
7960pointer based on the stored type information.
7961Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
7962
c906108c
SS
7963@item .*@r{, }->*
7964Dereferences of pointers to members.
c906108c
SS
7965
7966@item []
7967Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
7968@code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
7969
7970@item ()
7971Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
7972
c906108c 7973@item ::
b37052ae 7974C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
7a292a7a 7975and @code{class} types.
c906108c
SS
7976
7977@item ::
7a292a7a
SS
7978Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
7979(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
7980above.
c906108c
SS
7981@end table
7982
c906108c
SS
7983If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
7984attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
7985predefined meaning.
c906108c 7986
c906108c 7987@menu
5d161b24 7988* C Constants::
c906108c
SS
7989@end menu
7990
6d2ebf8b 7991@node C Constants
b37052ae 7992@subsubsection C and C@t{++} constants
c906108c 7993
b37052ae 7994@cindex C and C@t{++} constants
c906108c 7995
b37052ae 7996@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
c906108c 7997following ways:
c906108c
SS
7998
7999@itemize @bullet
8000@item
8001Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
6ca652b0
EZ
8002specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
8003by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
c906108c
SS
8004@samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
8005@code{long} value.
8006
8007@item
8008Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
8009point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
8010exponent. An exponent is of the form:
8011@samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
8012sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
d4f3574e
SS
8013A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
8014@samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
8015the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
8016a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
8017constant.
c906108c
SS
8018
8019@item
8020Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
8021integral equivalents.
8022
8023@item
8024Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
8025(@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
d4f3574e 8026(usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
c906108c
SS
8027be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
8028the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
8029of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
8030@samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
8031@samp{\n} for newline.
8032
8033@item
96a2c332
SS
8034String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
8035double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
8036above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
8037a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
8038characters.
c906108c
SS
8039
8040@item
8041Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
8042to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
8043
8044@item
8045Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
8046and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
8047integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
8048and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
8049@end itemize
8050
c906108c 8051@menu
5d161b24
DB
8052* C plus plus expressions::
8053* C Defaults::
8054* C Checks::
c906108c 8055
5d161b24 8056* Debugging C::
c906108c
SS
8057@end menu
8058
6d2ebf8b 8059@node C plus plus expressions
b37052ae
EZ
8060@subsubsection C@t{++} expressions
8061
8062@cindex expressions in C@t{++}
8063@value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
8064
8065@cindex C@t{++} support, not in @sc{coff}
8066@cindex @sc{coff} versus C@t{++}
8067@cindex C@t{++} and object formats
8068@cindex object formats and C@t{++}
8069@cindex a.out and C@t{++}
8070@cindex @sc{ecoff} and C@t{++}
8071@cindex @sc{xcoff} and C@t{++}
8072@cindex @sc{elf}/stabs and C@t{++}
8073@cindex @sc{elf}/@sc{dwarf} and C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
8074@c FIXME!! GDB may eventually be able to debug C++ using DWARF; check
8075@c periodically whether this has happened...
8076@quotation
b37052ae
EZ
8077@emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
8078proper compiler. Typically, C@t{++} debugging depends on the use of
c906108c
SS
8079additional debugging information in the symbol table, and thus requires
8080special support. In particular, if your compiler generates a.out, MIPS
8081@sc{ecoff}, RS/6000 @sc{xcoff}, or @sc{elf} with stabs extensions to the
8082symbol table, these facilities are all available. (With @sc{gnu} CC,
8083you can use the @samp{-gstabs} option to request stabs debugging
8084extensions explicitly.) Where the object code format is standard
b37052ae 8085@sc{coff} or @sc{dwarf} in @sc{elf}, on the other hand, most of the C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
8086support in @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} work.
8087@end quotation
c906108c
SS
8088
8089@enumerate
8090
8091@cindex member functions
8092@item
8093Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
8094
474c8240 8095@smallexample
c906108c 8096count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
474c8240 8097@end smallexample
c906108c 8098
41afff9a 8099@vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
b37052ae 8100@cindex namespace in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
8101@item
8102While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
8103expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
8104that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
b37052ae 8105pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
c906108c 8106
c906108c 8107@cindex call overloaded functions
d4f3574e 8108@cindex overloaded functions, calling
b37052ae 8109@cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
8110@item
8111You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
d4f3574e 8112call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
c906108c
SS
8113perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
8114calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
8115in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
8116default arguments.
8117
8118It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
8119promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
8120class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
8121functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
8122number of function arguments.
8123
8124Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
8125@code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C plus plus,
b37052ae 8126,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
c906108c 8127
d4f3574e 8128You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
c906108c
SS
8129explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
8130@smallexample
8131p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
8132@end smallexample
d4f3574e 8133
c906108c 8134The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
d4f3574e 8135see @ref{Completion, ,Command completion}.
c906108c 8136
c906108c
SS
8137@cindex reference declarations
8138@item
b37052ae
EZ
8139@value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
8140them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
c906108c
SS
8141dereferenced.
8142
8143In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
8144reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
8145avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
8146The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
8147you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
8148
8149@item
b37052ae 8150@value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
c906108c
SS
8151expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
8152one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
8153necessary, for example in an expression like
8154@samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
b37052ae 8155resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
8156debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program variables}).
8157@end enumerate
8158
b37052ae 8159In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
53a5351d
JM
8160calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
8161objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
8162invoking user-defined operators.
c906108c 8163
6d2ebf8b 8164@node C Defaults
b37052ae 8165@subsubsection C and C@t{++} defaults
7a292a7a 8166
b37052ae 8167@cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
c906108c 8168
c906108c
SS
8169If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
8170both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
b37052ae 8171C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
c906108c 8172selects the working language.
c906108c
SS
8173
8174If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
8175recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
8176@file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
b37052ae 8177these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
c906108c
SS
8178@xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language},
8179for further details.
8180
c906108c
SS
8181@c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
8182@c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
8183@c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
7a292a7a 8184
6d2ebf8b 8185@node C Checks
b37052ae 8186@subsubsection C and C@t{++} type and range checks
7a292a7a 8187
b37052ae 8188@cindex C and C@t{++} checks
c906108c 8189
b37052ae 8190By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
c906108c
SS
8191is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
8192considers two variables type equivalent if:
8193
8194@itemize @bullet
8195@item
8196The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
8197enumerated tag.
8198
8199@item
8200The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
8201declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
8202
8203@ignore
8204@c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
8205@c FIXME--beers?
8206@item
8207The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
8208declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
8209compilers.)
8210@end ignore
8211@end itemize
8212
8213Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
8214indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
8215that is not itself an array.
c906108c 8216
6d2ebf8b 8217@node Debugging C
c906108c 8218@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
c906108c
SS
8219
8220The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
8221the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
7a292a7a
SS
8222inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
8223appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
c906108c
SS
8224
8225The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
8226with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
8227,Expressions}.
8228
c906108c 8229@menu
5d161b24 8230* Debugging C plus plus::
c906108c
SS
8231@end menu
8232
6d2ebf8b 8233@node Debugging C plus plus
b37052ae 8234@subsubsection @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
c906108c 8235
b37052ae 8236@cindex commands for C@t{++}
7a292a7a 8237
b37052ae
EZ
8238Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
8239designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
c906108c
SS
8240
8241@table @code
8242@cindex break in overloaded functions
8243@item @r{breakpoint menus}
8244When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
8245@value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
8246you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}.
8247
b37052ae 8248@cindex overloading in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
8249@item rbreak @var{regex}
8250Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
8251breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
8252classes.
8253@xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.
8254
b37052ae 8255@cindex C@t{++} exception handling
c906108c
SS
8256@item catch throw
8257@itemx catch catch
b37052ae 8258Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
c906108c
SS
8259Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
8260
8261@cindex inheritance
8262@item ptype @var{typename}
8263Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
8264@var{typename}.
8265@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
8266
b37052ae 8267@cindex C@t{++} symbol display
c906108c
SS
8268@item set print demangle
8269@itemx show print demangle
8270@itemx set print asm-demangle
8271@itemx show print asm-demangle
b37052ae
EZ
8272Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
8273displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
c906108c
SS
8274@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
8275
8276@item set print object
8277@itemx show print object
8278Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
8279@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
8280
8281@item set print vtbl
8282@itemx show print vtbl
8283Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
8284@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
c906108c 8285(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
b37052ae 8286ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
c906108c
SS
8287
8288@kindex set overload-resolution
d4f3574e 8289@cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
c906108c 8290@item set overload-resolution on
b37052ae 8291Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
c906108c
SS
8292is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
8293and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
b37052ae 8294using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C plus plus expressions, ,C@t{++}
d4f3574e 8295expressions}, for details). If it cannot find a match, it emits a
c906108c
SS
8296message.
8297
8298@item set overload-resolution off
b37052ae 8299Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
c906108c
SS
8300overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
8301chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
8302symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
8303overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
8304searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
8305argument types.
c906108c
SS
8306
8307@item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
8308You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
b37052ae 8309the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
c906108c
SS
8310@code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
8311also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
8312available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
8313@xref{Completion,, Command completion}, for details on how to do this.
8314@end table
c906108c 8315
6d2ebf8b 8316@node Modula-2
c906108c 8317@subsection Modula-2
7a292a7a 8318
d4f3574e 8319@cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
c906108c
SS
8320
8321The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
8322output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
8323developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
8324attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
8325to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
8326table.
8327
8328@cindex expressions in Modula-2
8329@menu
8330* M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
8331* Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
8332* M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
8333* M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
8334* Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
8335* M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
8336* M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
8337* GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
8338@end menu
8339
6d2ebf8b 8340@node M2 Operators
c906108c
SS
8341@subsubsection Operators
8342@cindex Modula-2 operators
8343
8344Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
8345@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
8346often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
8347following definitions hold:
8348
8349@itemize @bullet
8350
8351@item
8352@emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
8353their subranges.
8354
8355@item
8356@emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
8357
8358@item
8359@emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
8360
8361@item
8362@emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
8363@var{type}}.
8364
8365@item
8366@emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
8367
8368@item
8369@emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
8370
8371@item
8372@emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
8373@end itemize
8374
8375@noindent
8376The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
8377increasing precedence:
8378
8379@table @code
8380@item ,
8381Function argument or array index separator.
8382
8383@item :=
8384Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
8385@var{value}.
8386
8387@item <@r{, }>
8388Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
8389types.
8390
8391@item <=@r{, }>=
96a2c332 8392Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
c906108c
SS
8393on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
8394set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
8395
8396@item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
8397Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
8398Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
8399available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
8400comment character.
8401
8402@item IN
8403Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
8404Same precedence as @code{<}.
8405
8406@item OR
8407Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
8408
8409@item AND@r{, }&
d4f3574e 8410Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
c906108c
SS
8411
8412@item @@
8413The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
8414
8415@item +@r{, }-
8416Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
8417and difference on set types.
8418
8419@item *
8420Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
8421on set types.
8422
8423@item /
8424Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
8425types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
8426
8427@item DIV@r{, }MOD
8428Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
8429precedence as @code{*}.
8430
8431@item -
8432Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
8433
8434@item ^
8435Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
8436
8437@item NOT
8438Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
8439@code{^}.
8440
8441@item .
8442@code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
8443precedence as @code{^}.
8444
8445@item []
8446Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
8447
8448@item ()
8449Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
8450as @code{^}.
8451
8452@item ::@r{, }.
8453@value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
8454@end table
8455
8456@quotation
8457@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
8458treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
8459@code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
8460@code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
8461@end quotation
8462
cb51c4e0 8463
6d2ebf8b 8464@node Built-In Func/Proc
c906108c 8465@subsubsection Built-in functions and procedures
cb51c4e0 8466@cindex Modula-2 built-ins
c906108c
SS
8467
8468Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
8469In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
8470
8471@table @var
8472
8473@item a
8474represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
8475
8476@item c
8477represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
8478
8479@item i
8480represents a variable or constant of integral type.
8481
8482@item m
8483represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
8484same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
8485be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
8486
8487@item n
8488represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
8489
8490@item r
8491represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
8492
8493@item t
8494represents a type.
8495
8496@item v
8497represents a variable.
8498
8499@item x
8500represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
8501explanation of the function for details.
8502@end table
8503
8504All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
8505
8506@table @code
8507@item ABS(@var{n})
8508Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
8509
8510@item CAP(@var{c})
8511If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
c3f6f71d 8512equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
c906108c
SS
8513
8514@item CHR(@var{i})
8515Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
8516
8517@item DEC(@var{v})
c3f6f71d 8518Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
c906108c
SS
8519
8520@item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
8521Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
8522new value.
8523
8524@item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
8525Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
8526set.
8527
8528@item FLOAT(@var{i})
8529Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
8530
8531@item HIGH(@var{a})
8532Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
8533
8534@item INC(@var{v})
c3f6f71d 8535Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
c906108c
SS
8536
8537@item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
8538Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
8539new value.
8540
8541@item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
8542Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
8543there. Returns the new set.
8544
8545@item MAX(@var{t})
8546Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
8547
8548@item MIN(@var{t})
8549Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
8550
8551@item ODD(@var{i})
8552Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
8553
8554@item ORD(@var{x})
8555Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
c3f6f71d
JM
8556value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
8557@sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
c906108c
SS
8558integral, character and enumerated types.
8559
8560@item SIZE(@var{x})
8561Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
8562
8563@item TRUNC(@var{r})
8564Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
8565
8566@item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
8567Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
8568@end table
8569
8570@quotation
8571@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
8572@value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
8573an error.
8574@end quotation
8575
8576@cindex Modula-2 constants
6d2ebf8b 8577@node M2 Constants
c906108c
SS
8578@subsubsection Constants
8579
8580@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
8581ways:
8582
8583@itemize @bullet
8584
8585@item
8586Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
8587expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
8588rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
8589trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
8590
8591@item
8592Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
8593decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
8594then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
8595@samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
8596digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
8597digits.
8598
8599@item
8600Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
8601like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
c3f6f71d 8602also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
c906108c
SS
8603followed by a @samp{C}.
8604
8605@item
8606String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
8607pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
8608Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
b37052ae 8609Constants, ,C and C@t{++} constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
c906108c
SS
8610sequences.
8611
8612@item
8613Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
8614
8615@item
8616Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
8617@code{FALSE}.
8618
8619@item
8620Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
8621
8622@item
8623Set constants are not yet supported.
8624@end itemize
8625
6d2ebf8b 8626@node M2 Defaults
c906108c
SS
8627@subsubsection Modula-2 defaults
8628@cindex Modula-2 defaults
8629
8630If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
8631both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
d4f3574e 8632Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
8633selected the working language.
8634
8635If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
8636code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
d4f3574e 8637working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
c906108c
SS
8638the language automatically}, for further details.
8639
6d2ebf8b 8640@node Deviations
c906108c
SS
8641@subsubsection Deviations from standard Modula-2
8642@cindex Modula-2, deviations from
8643
8644A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
8645This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
8646
8647@itemize @bullet
8648@item
8649Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
8650integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
8651debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
8652pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
8653through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
8654returned a pointer.)
8655
8656@item
8657C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
8658non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
8659escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
8660printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
8661
8662@item
8663The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
8664argument.
8665
8666@item
8667All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
8668@end itemize
8669
6d2ebf8b 8670@node M2 Checks
c906108c
SS
8671@subsubsection Modula-2 type and range checks
8672@cindex Modula-2 checks
8673
8674@quotation
8675@emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
8676range checking.
8677@end quotation
8678@c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
8679
8680@value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
8681
8682@itemize @bullet
8683@item
8684They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
8685@var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
8686
8687@item
8688They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
8689@sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
8690@end itemize
8691
8692As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
8693whose types are not equivalent is an error.
8694
8695Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
8696index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
8697
6d2ebf8b 8698@node M2 Scope
c906108c
SS
8699@subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
8700@cindex scope
41afff9a 8701@cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
c906108c
SS
8702@cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
8703@ifinfo
41afff9a 8704@vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
c906108c
SS
8705@c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
8706@end ifinfo
8707@iftex
41afff9a 8708@vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
c906108c
SS
8709@end iftex
8710
8711There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
8712(@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
8713similar syntax:
8714
474c8240 8715@smallexample
c906108c
SS
8716
8717@var{module} . @var{id}
8718@var{scope} :: @var{id}
474c8240 8719@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
8720
8721@noindent
8722where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
8723@var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
8724identifier within your program, except another module.
8725
8726Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
8727specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
8728found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
8729enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
8730
8731Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
8732the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
8733definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
8734an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
8735module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
8736@var{module}.
8737
6d2ebf8b 8738@node GDB/M2
c906108c
SS
8739@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
8740
8741Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
8742Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
b37052ae 8743specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
c906108c 8744@samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
b37052ae 8745apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
c906108c
SS
8746analogue in Modula-2.
8747
8748The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
d4f3574e 8749with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
c906108c 8750intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
b37052ae 8751created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
c906108c 8752address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
d4f3574e 8753@samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
c906108c
SS
8754
8755@cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
8756In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
8757interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
c906108c 8758
6d2ebf8b 8759@node Symbols
c906108c
SS
8760@chapter Examining the Symbol Table
8761
d4f3574e 8762The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
c906108c
SS
8763symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
8764program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
8765does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
8766program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
8767(@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing files}), or by one of the
8768file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
8769
8770@cindex symbol names
8771@cindex names of symbols
8772@cindex quoting names
8773Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
8774characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
8775most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
8776source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program variables}). File names
8777are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
8778ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
8779@samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
8780@samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
8781
474c8240 8782@smallexample
c906108c 8783p 'foo.c'::x
474c8240 8784@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
8785
8786@noindent
8787looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
8788
8789@table @code
8790@kindex info address
b37052ae 8791@cindex address of a symbol
c906108c
SS
8792@item info address @var{symbol}
8793Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
8794variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
8795local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
8796is always stored.
8797
8798Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
8799at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
8800the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
8801
3d67e040 8802@kindex info symbol
b37052ae 8803@cindex symbol from address
3d67e040
EZ
8804@item info symbol @var{addr}
8805Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
8806If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
8807nearest symbol and an offset from it:
8808
474c8240 8809@smallexample
3d67e040
EZ
8810(@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
8811_initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
474c8240 8812@end smallexample
3d67e040
EZ
8813
8814@noindent
8815This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
8816it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
8817
c906108c 8818@kindex whatis
d4f3574e
SS
8819@item whatis @var{expr}
8820Print the data type of expression @var{expr}. @var{expr} is not
c906108c
SS
8821actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
8822assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
8823@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
8824
8825@item whatis
8826Print the data type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
8827
8828@kindex ptype
8829@item ptype @var{typename}
8830Print a description of data type @var{typename}. @var{typename} may be
7a292a7a
SS
8831the name of a type, or for C code it may have the form @samp{class
8832@var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
8833@var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
c906108c 8834
d4f3574e 8835@item ptype @var{expr}
c906108c 8836@itemx ptype
d4f3574e 8837Print a description of the type of expression @var{expr}. @code{ptype}
c906108c
SS
8838differs from @code{whatis} by printing a detailed description, instead
8839of just the name of the type.
8840
8841For example, for this variable declaration:
8842
474c8240 8843@smallexample
c906108c 8844struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
474c8240 8845@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
8846
8847@noindent
8848the two commands give this output:
8849
474c8240 8850@smallexample
c906108c
SS
8851@group
8852(@value{GDBP}) whatis v
8853type = struct complex
8854(@value{GDBP}) ptype v
8855type = struct complex @{
8856 double real;
8857 double imag;
8858@}
8859@end group
474c8240 8860@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
8861
8862@noindent
8863As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
8864the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
8865
8866@kindex info types
8867@item info types @var{regexp}
8868@itemx info types
d4f3574e 8869Print a brief description of all types whose names match @var{regexp}
c906108c
SS
8870(or all types in your program, if you supply no argument). Each
8871complete typename is matched as though it were a complete line; thus,
8872@samp{i type value} gives information on all types in your program whose
d4f3574e 8873names include the string @code{value}, but @samp{i type ^value$} gives
c906108c
SS
8874information only on types whose complete name is @code{value}.
8875
8876This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
8877@code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
8878lists all source files where a type is defined.
8879
b37052ae
EZ
8880@kindex info scope
8881@cindex local variables
8882@item info scope @var{addr}
8883List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
8884accepts a location---a function name, a source line, or an address
8885preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local to the
8886scope defined by that location. For example:
8887
8888@smallexample
8889(@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
8890Scope for command_line_handler:
8891Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
8892Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
8893Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
8894Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
8895Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
8896Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
8897Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
8898@end smallexample
8899
f5c37c66
EZ
8900@noindent
8901This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
8902during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
8903collect}.
8904
c906108c
SS
8905@kindex info source
8906@item info source
919d772c
JB
8907Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
8908the function containing the current point of execution:
8909@itemize @bullet
8910@item
8911the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
8912@item
8913the directory it was compiled in,
8914@item
8915its length, in lines,
8916@item
8917which programming language it is written in,
8918@item
8919whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
8920if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
8921@item
8922whether the debugging information includes information about
8923preprocessor macros.
8924@end itemize
8925
c906108c
SS
8926
8927@kindex info sources
8928@item info sources
8929Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
8930debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
8931have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
8932
8933@kindex info functions
8934@item info functions
8935Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
8936
8937@item info functions @var{regexp}
8938Print the names and data types of all defined functions
8939whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
8940Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
8941include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
1c5dfdad
MS
8942start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
8943that conflict with the regular expression language (eg.
8944@samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
c906108c
SS
8945
8946@kindex info variables
8947@item info variables
8948Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
6ca652b0 8949outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
c906108c
SS
8950
8951@item info variables @var{regexp}
8952Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
8953variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
8954@var{regexp}.
8955
8956@ignore
8957This was never implemented.
8958@kindex info methods
8959@item info methods
8960@itemx info methods @var{regexp}
8961The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
b37052ae
EZ
8962methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
8963specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
8964C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
c906108c
SS
8965from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
8966@code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
8967which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
8968@end ignore
8969
c906108c
SS
8970@cindex reloading symbols
8971Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
7a292a7a
SS
8972be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
8973in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
8974running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
8975@value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
c906108c
SS
8976
8977@table @code
8978@kindex set symbol-reloading
8979@item set symbol-reloading on
8980Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
8981object file with a particular name is seen again.
8982
8983@item set symbol-reloading off
6d2ebf8b
SS
8984Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
8985same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
8986running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
8987should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
8988may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
8989several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
8990name.
c906108c
SS
8991
8992@kindex show symbol-reloading
8993@item show symbol-reloading
8994Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
8995@end table
c906108c 8996
c906108c
SS
8997@kindex set opaque-type-resolution
8998@item set opaque-type-resolution on
8999Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
9000declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
9001@code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
9002source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
9003another source file. The default is on.
9004
9005A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
9006the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
9007
9008@item set opaque-type-resolution off
9009Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
9010is printed as follows:
9011@smallexample
9012@{<no data fields>@}
9013@end smallexample
9014
9015@kindex show opaque-type-resolution
9016@item show opaque-type-resolution
9017Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
c906108c
SS
9018
9019@kindex maint print symbols
9020@cindex symbol dump
9021@kindex maint print psymbols
9022@cindex partial symbol dump
9023@item maint print symbols @var{filename}
9024@itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
9025@itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
9026Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
9027These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
9028symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
9029symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
9030collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
9031only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
9032command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
9033use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
9034symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
9035files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
9036@samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
9037required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
9038@xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}, for a discussion of how
9039@value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
9040@end table
9041
6d2ebf8b 9042@node Altering
c906108c
SS
9043@chapter Altering Execution
9044
9045Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
9046find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
9047correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
9048experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
9049program.
9050
9051For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
7a292a7a
SS
9052locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
9053address, or even return prematurely from a function.
c906108c
SS
9054
9055@menu
9056* Assignment:: Assignment to variables
9057* Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
c906108c 9058* Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
c906108c
SS
9059* Returning:: Returning from a function
9060* Calling:: Calling your program's functions
9061* Patching:: Patching your program
9062@end menu
9063
6d2ebf8b 9064@node Assignment
c906108c
SS
9065@section Assignment to variables
9066
9067@cindex assignment
9068@cindex setting variables
9069To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
9070@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
9071
474c8240 9072@smallexample
c906108c 9073print x=4
474c8240 9074@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9075
9076@noindent
9077stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
5d161b24 9078value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
c906108c
SS
9079@xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
9080information on operators in supported languages.
c906108c
SS
9081
9082@kindex set variable
9083@cindex variables, setting
9084If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
9085@code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
9086really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
9087not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
9088,Value history}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
9089
c906108c
SS
9090If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
9091appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
9092variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
9093to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
9094program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
9095a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
9096command @code{set width}:
9097
474c8240 9098@smallexample
c906108c
SS
9099(@value{GDBP}) whatis width
9100type = double
9101(@value{GDBP}) p width
9102$4 = 13
9103(@value{GDBP}) set width=47
9104Invalid syntax in expression.
474c8240 9105@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9106
9107@noindent
9108The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
9109order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
9110
474c8240 9111@smallexample
c906108c 9112(@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
474c8240 9113@end smallexample
53a5351d 9114
c906108c
SS
9115Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
9116with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
9117@code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
9118your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
9119to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
9120the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
9121
474c8240 9122@smallexample
c906108c
SS
9123@group
9124(@value{GDBP}) whatis g
9125type = double
9126(@value{GDBP}) p g
9127$1 = 1
9128(@value{GDBP}) set g=4
2df3850c 9129(@value{GDBP}) p g
c906108c
SS
9130$2 = 1
9131(@value{GDBP}) r
9132The program being debugged has been started already.
9133Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
9134Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
6d2ebf8b
SS
9135"/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
9136 Invalid bfd target.
c906108c
SS
9137(@value{GDBP}) show g
9138The current BFD target is "=4".
9139@end group
474c8240 9140@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9141
9142@noindent
9143The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
9144@code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
9145@code{g}, use
9146
474c8240 9147@smallexample
c906108c 9148(@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
474c8240 9149@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9150
9151@value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
9152freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
9153and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
9154same length or shorter.
9155@comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
9156@comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
9157
9158To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
9159construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
9160(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
9161to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
9162and representation in memory), and
9163
474c8240 9164@smallexample
c906108c 9165set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
474c8240 9166@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9167
9168@noindent
9169stores the value 4 into that memory location.
9170
6d2ebf8b 9171@node Jumping
c906108c
SS
9172@section Continuing at a different address
9173
9174Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
9175it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
9176an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
9177
9178@table @code
9179@kindex jump
9180@item jump @var{linespec}
9181Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
9182immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
9183source lines}, for a description of the different forms of
9184@var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
9185in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
9186breakpoints}.
9187
9188The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
9189the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
9190register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
9191a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
9192be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
9193of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
9194confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
9195executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
9196well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
9197
9198@item jump *@var{address}
9199Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
9200@end table
9201
c906108c 9202@c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
53a5351d
JM
9203On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
9204command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
9205difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
9206changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
9207example,
c906108c 9208
474c8240 9209@smallexample
c906108c 9210set $pc = 0x485
474c8240 9211@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9212
9213@noindent
9214makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
9215address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
9216@xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}.
c906108c
SS
9217
9218The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
9219up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
9220that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
9221detail.
9222
c906108c 9223@c @group
6d2ebf8b 9224@node Signaling
c906108c
SS
9225@section Giving your program a signal
9226
9227@table @code
9228@kindex signal
9229@item signal @var{signal}
9230Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
9231signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
9232signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
9233SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
9234
9235Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
9236giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
9237a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
9238@code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
9239signal.
9240
9241@code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
9242after executing the command.
9243@end table
9244@c @end group
9245
9246Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
9247@code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
9248causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
9249the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
9250passes the signal directly to your program.
9251
c906108c 9252
6d2ebf8b 9253@node Returning
c906108c
SS
9254@section Returning from a function
9255
9256@table @code
9257@cindex returning from a function
9258@kindex return
9259@item return
9260@itemx return @var{expression}
9261You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
9262command. If you give an
9263@var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
9264value.
9265@end table
9266
9267When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
9268(and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
9269discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
9270be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
9271
9272This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
9273frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
9274innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
9275specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
9276of functions.
9277
9278The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
9279program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
9280returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
9281and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}) resumes execution until the
9282selected stack frame returns naturally.
9283
6d2ebf8b 9284@node Calling
c906108c
SS
9285@section Calling program functions
9286
9287@cindex calling functions
9288@kindex call
9289@table @code
9290@item call @var{expr}
9291Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
9292returned values.
9293@end table
9294
9295You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
9296execute a function from your program, but without cluttering the output
5d161b24
DB
9297with @code{void} returned values. If the result is not void, it
9298is printed and saved in the value history.
c906108c 9299
6d2ebf8b 9300@node Patching
c906108c 9301@section Patching programs
7a292a7a 9302
c906108c
SS
9303@cindex patching binaries
9304@cindex writing into executables
c906108c 9305@cindex writing into corefiles
c906108c 9306
7a292a7a
SS
9307By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
9308executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
9309alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
9310patching your program's binary.
c906108c
SS
9311
9312If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
9313explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
9314want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
9315repairs.
9316
9317@table @code
9318@kindex set write
9319@item set write on
9320@itemx set write off
7a292a7a
SS
9321If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
9322core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
c906108c
SS
9323off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
9324
9325If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
7a292a7a
SS
9326@code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
9327write}, for your new setting to take effect.
c906108c
SS
9328
9329@item show write
9330@kindex show write
7a292a7a
SS
9331Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
9332as well as reading.
c906108c
SS
9333@end table
9334
6d2ebf8b 9335@node GDB Files
c906108c
SS
9336@chapter @value{GDBN} Files
9337
7a292a7a
SS
9338@value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
9339both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
9340program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
9341@value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
c906108c
SS
9342
9343@menu
9344* Files:: Commands to specify files
9345* Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
9346@end menu
9347
6d2ebf8b 9348@node Files
c906108c 9349@section Commands to specify files
c906108c 9350
7a292a7a 9351@cindex symbol table
c906108c 9352@cindex core dump file
7a292a7a
SS
9353
9354You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
9355way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
9356@value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
9357Out of @value{GDBN}}).
c906108c
SS
9358
9359Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
9360@value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to specify
9361a file you want to use. In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands
9362to specify new files are useful.
9363
9364@table @code
9365@cindex executable file
9366@kindex file
9367@item file @var{filename}
9368Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
9369symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
9370executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
5d161b24
DB
9371directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
9372@value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
9373directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
9374to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
9375and your program, using the @code{path} command.
9376
6d2ebf8b 9377On systems with memory-mapped files, an auxiliary file named
c906108c
SS
9378@file{@var{filename}.syms} may hold symbol table information for
9379@var{filename}. If so, @value{GDBN} maps in the symbol table from
9380@file{@var{filename}.syms}, starting up more quickly. See the
9381descriptions of the file options @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow}
9382(available on the command line, and with the commands @code{file},
5d161b24 9383@code{symbol-file}, or @code{add-symbol-file}, described below),
c906108c 9384for more information.
c906108c
SS
9385
9386@item file
9387@code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
9388has on both executable file and the symbol table.
9389
9390@kindex exec-file
9391@item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9392Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
9393in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
9394if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
9395discard information on the executable file.
9396
9397@kindex symbol-file
9398@item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9399Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
9400searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
9401table and program to run from the same file.
9402
9403@code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
9404program's symbol table.
9405
5d161b24 9406The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents
c906108c
SS
9407of its convenience variables, the value history, and all breakpoints and
9408auto-display expressions. This is because they may contain pointers to
9409the internal data recording symbols and data types, which are part of
9410the old symbol table data being discarded inside @value{GDBN}.
9411
9412@code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
9413executing it once.
9414
9415When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
9416understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
9417generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
9418other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
c906108c
SS
9419Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
9420using @code{@value{GCC}} you can generate debugging information for
9421optimized code.
c906108c
SS
9422
9423For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
9424using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
9425symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
9426quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
9427details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
9428
9429The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
9430start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
9431occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
9432file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
9433pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
9434warnings and messages}.)
9435
c906108c
SS
9436We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
9437symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
9438symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
9439still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
9440in stabs format.
9441
9442@kindex readnow
9443@cindex reading symbols immediately
9444@cindex symbols, reading immediately
9445@kindex mapped
9446@cindex memory-mapped symbol file
9447@cindex saving symbol table
9448@item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
9449@itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
9450You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
9451tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
9452load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
5d161b24 9453entire symbol table available.
c906108c 9454
c906108c
SS
9455If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the
9456@code{mmap} system call, you can use another option, @samp{-mapped}, to
9457cause @value{GDBN} to write the symbols for your program into a reusable
9458file. Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions map in symbol information
9459from this auxiliary symbol file (if the program has not changed), rather
9460than spending time reading the symbol table from the executable
9461program. Using the @samp{-mapped} option has the same effect as
9462starting @value{GDBN} with the @samp{-mapped} command-line option.
9463
9464You can use both options together, to make sure the auxiliary symbol
9465file has all the symbol information for your program.
9466
9467The auxiliary symbol file for a program called @var{myprog} is called
9468@samp{@var{myprog}.syms}. Once this file exists (so long as it is newer
9469than the corresponding executable), @value{GDBN} always attempts to use
9470it when you debug @var{myprog}; no special options or commands are
9471needed.
9472
9473The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where you run
9474@value{GDBN}. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN}
9475symbol table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c
SS
9476
9477@c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
9478@c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
9479@c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
9480@c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
9481@c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
9482@c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
9483@c files.
9484
9485@kindex core
9486@kindex core-file
9487@item core-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9488Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
9489of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
9490address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
9491executable file itself for other parts.
9492
9493@code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
9494to be used.
9495
9496Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
7a292a7a
SS
9497under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
9498wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
9499the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
c906108c 9500(@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the child process}).
c906108c 9501
c906108c
SS
9502@kindex add-symbol-file
9503@cindex dynamic linking
9504@item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
9505@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
17d9d558 9506@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
96a2c332
SS
9507The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
9508information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
9509when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
9510into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
9511address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
d167840f
EZ
9512this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
9513of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
9514section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
9515@var{address} as an expression.
c906108c
SS
9516
9517The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
9518originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
96a2c332
SS
9519@code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
9520thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
9521instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
c906108c 9522
17d9d558
JB
9523@cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
9524@cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
9525@cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
9526@cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
9527@cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
9528Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
9529executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
9530relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
9531information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
9532
9533@itemize @bullet
9534@item
9535the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
9536that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
9537@item
9538every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
9539been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
9540@item
9541you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
9542provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
9543@end itemize
9544
9545@noindent
9546Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
9547relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
9548typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
9549important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
9550procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C++ constructor table
9551assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
9552general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
9553relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
9554as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
9555way.
9556
c906108c
SS
9557@code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
9558
9559You can use the @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow} options just as with
9560the @code{symbol-file} command, to change how @value{GDBN} manages the symbol
9561table information for @var{filename}.
9562
9563@kindex add-shared-symbol-file
9564@item add-shared-symbol-file
9565The @code{add-shared-symbol-file} command can be used only under Harris' CXUX
5d161b24
DB
9566operating system for the Motorola 88k. @value{GDBN} automatically looks for
9567shared libraries, however if @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can run
c906108c 9568@code{add-shared-symbol-file}. It takes no arguments.
c906108c 9569
c906108c
SS
9570@kindex section
9571@item section
5d161b24
DB
9572The @code{section} command changes the base address of section SECTION of
9573the exec file to ADDR. This can be used if the exec file does not contain
9574section addresses, (such as in the a.out format), or when the addresses
9575specified in the file itself are wrong. Each section must be changed
d4f3574e
SS
9576separately. The @code{info files} command, described below, lists all
9577the sections and their addresses.
c906108c
SS
9578
9579@kindex info files
9580@kindex info target
9581@item info files
9582@itemx info target
7a292a7a
SS
9583@code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
9584current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
9585including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
9586use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
9587command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
9588current ones.
9589
fe95c787
MS
9590@kindex maint info sections
9591@item maint info sections
9592Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
9593is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
9594displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
9595offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
9596@code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
9597may be arbitrarily combined):
9598
9599@table @code
9600@item ALLOBJ
9601Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
9602@item @var{sections}
6600abed 9603Display info only for named @var{sections}.
fe95c787
MS
9604@item @var{section-flags}
9605Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
9606The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
9607@table @code
9608@item ALLOC
9609Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
9610Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
9611@item LOAD
9612Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
9613Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
9614@item RELOC
9615Section needs to be relocated before loading.
9616@item READONLY
9617Section cannot be modified by the child process.
9618@item CODE
9619Section contains executable code only.
6600abed 9620@item DATA
fe95c787
MS
9621Section contains data only (no executable code).
9622@item ROM
9623Section will reside in ROM.
9624@item CONSTRUCTOR
9625Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
9626@item HAS_CONTENTS
9627Section is not empty.
9628@item NEVER_LOAD
9629An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
9630@item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
9631A notification to the linker that the section contains
9632COFF shared library information.
9633@item IS_COMMON
9634Section contains common symbols.
9635@end table
9636@end table
6763aef9
MS
9637@kindex set trust-readonly-sections
9638@item set trust-readonly-sections on
9639Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
6ca652b0 9640really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
6763aef9
MS
9641In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
9642out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
9643For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
9644enhancement to debugging performance.
9645
9646The default is off.
9647
9648@item set trust-readonly-sections off
15110bc3 9649Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
6763aef9
MS
9650the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
9651and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
c906108c
SS
9652@end table
9653
9654All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
9655as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
9656name and remembers it that way.
9657
c906108c 9658@cindex shared libraries
c906108c
SS
9659@value{GDBN} supports HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix 5, and IBM RS/6000 shared
9660libraries.
53a5351d 9661
c906108c
SS
9662@value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
9663when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
9664(Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
9665references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
9666debugging a core file).
53a5351d
JM
9667
9668On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
9669automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
9670
c906108c
SS
9671@c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
9672@c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
9673@c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
9674
b7209cb4
FF
9675There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
9676symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
9677particularly large or there are many of them.
9678
9679To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
9680commands:
9681
9682@table @code
9683@kindex set auto-solib-add
9684@item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
9685If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
9686will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
9687attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
9688informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
9689is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
9690@code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
9691
9692@kindex show auto-solib-add
9693@item show auto-solib-add
9694Display the current autoloading mode.
9695@end table
9696
9697To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
9698command:
9699
c906108c
SS
9700@table @code
9701@kindex info sharedlibrary
9702@kindex info share
9703@item info share
9704@itemx info sharedlibrary
9705Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
9706
9707@kindex sharedlibrary
9708@kindex share
9709@item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
9710@itemx share @var{regex}
c906108c
SS
9711Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
9712Unix regular expression.
9713As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
9714required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
9715@var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
9716loaded.
9717@end table
9718
b7209cb4
FF
9719On some systems, such as HP-UX systems, @value{GDBN} supports
9720autoloading shared library symbols until a limiting threshold size is
9721reached. This provides the benefit of allowing autoloading to remain on
9722by default, but avoids autoloading excessively large shared libraries,
9723up to a threshold that is initially set, but which you can modify if you
9724wish.
c906108c
SS
9725
9726Beyond that threshold, symbols from shared libraries must be explicitly
d4f3574e
SS
9727loaded. To load these symbols, use the command @code{sharedlibrary
9728@var{filename}}. The base address of the shared library is determined
c906108c
SS
9729automatically by @value{GDBN} and need not be specified.
9730
9731To display or set the threshold, use the commands:
9732
9733@table @code
b7209cb4
FF
9734@kindex set auto-solib-limit
9735@item set auto-solib-limit @var{threshold}
9736Set the autoloading size threshold, in an integral number of megabytes.
9737If @var{threshold} is nonzero and shared library autoloading is enabled,
9738symbols from all shared object libraries will be loaded until the total
9739size of the loaded shared library symbols exceeds this threshold.
c906108c 9740Otherwise, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
6ca652b0 9741@code{sharedlibrary} command. The default threshold is 100 (i.e.@: 100
b7209cb4 9742Mb).
c906108c 9743
b7209cb4
FF
9744@kindex show auto-solib-limit
9745@item show auto-solib-limit
c906108c
SS
9746Display the current autoloading size threshold, in megabytes.
9747@end table
c906108c 9748
f5ebfba0
DJ
9749Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
9750configurations. A copy of the target's libraries need to be present on the
9751host system; they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
9752copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
9753not.
9754
9755You need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target libraries are, so that it can
9756load the correct copies---otherwise, it may try to load the host's libraries.
9757@value{GDBN} has two variables to specify the search directories for target
9758libraries.
9759
9760@table @code
9761@kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
9762@item set solib-absolute-prefix @var{path}
9763If this variable is set, @var{path} will be used as a prefix for any
9764absolute shared library paths; many runtime loaders store the absolute
9765paths to the shared library in the target program's memory. If you use
9766@samp{solib-absolute-prefix} to find shared libraries, they need to be laid
9767out in the same way that they are on the target, with e.g.@: a
9768@file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under @var{path}.
9769
9770You can set the default value of @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} by using the
9771configure-time @samp{--with-sysroot} option.
9772
9773@kindex show solib-absolute-prefix
9774@item show solib-absolute-prefix
9775Display the current shared library prefix.
9776
9777@kindex set solib-search-path
9778@item set solib-search-path @var{path}
9779If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of directories
9780to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path} is used after
9781@samp{solib-absolute-prefix} fails to locate the library, or if the path to
9782the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to use
9783@samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}, be sure to
9784set @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} to a nonexistant directory to prevent
9785@value{GDBN} from finding your host's libraries.
9786
9787@kindex show solib-search-path
9788@item show solib-search-path
9789Display the current shared library search path.
9790@end table
9791
6d2ebf8b 9792@node Symbol Errors
c906108c
SS
9793@section Errors reading symbol files
9794
9795While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
9796such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
9797output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
9798they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
9799debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
9800about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
9801only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
9802times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
9803to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
9804complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
9805messages}).
9806
9807The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
9808
9809@table @code
9810@item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
9811
9812The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
9813(such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
9814error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
9815in its outer scope blocks.
9816
9817@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
9818the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
9819may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
9820function.
9821
9822@item block at @var{address} out of order
9823
9824The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
9825order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
9826do so.
9827
9828@value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
9829locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
9830can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
9831@code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
9832messages}.)
9833
9834@item bad block start address patched
9835
9836The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
9837smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
9838to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
9839
9840@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
9841starting on the previous source line.
9842
9843@item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
9844
9845@cindex foo
9846Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
9847larger than the size of the string table.
9848
9849@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
9850name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
9851with this name.
9852
9853@item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
9854
7a292a7a
SS
9855The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
9856not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
d4f3574e 9857uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
c906108c 9858
7a292a7a
SS
9859@value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
9860This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
c906108c 9861are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
7a292a7a
SS
9862debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
9863on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
9864and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
c906108c
SS
9865
9866@item stub type has NULL name
c906108c 9867
7a292a7a 9868@value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
c906108c 9869
7a292a7a 9870@item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
b37052ae 9871The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
7a292a7a
SS
9872information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
9873it.
c906108c
SS
9874
9875@item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
9876
9877@value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
7a292a7a 9878
c906108c
SS
9879@end table
9880
6d2ebf8b 9881@node Targets
c906108c 9882@chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
7a292a7a 9883
c906108c
SS
9884@cindex debugging target
9885@kindex target
9886
9887A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
53a5351d
JM
9888
9889Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
9890in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
9891you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
c906108c
SS
9892flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
9893host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
53a5351d
JM
9894realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
9895command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
9896(@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
c906108c
SS
9897
9898@menu
9899* Active Targets:: Active targets
9900* Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
c906108c
SS
9901* Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
9902* Remote:: Remote debugging
96baa820 9903* KOD:: Kernel Object Display
c906108c
SS
9904
9905@end menu
9906
6d2ebf8b 9907@node Active Targets
c906108c 9908@section Active targets
7a292a7a 9909
c906108c
SS
9910@cindex stacking targets
9911@cindex active targets
9912@cindex multiple targets
9913
c906108c 9914There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
7a292a7a
SS
9915executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
9916active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
9917start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
9918a core file.
c906108c
SS
9919
9920For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
9921@code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
9922well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
9923@value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
9924first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
9925requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
9926are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
9927read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
9928executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
c906108c
SS
9929
9930When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
7a292a7a
SS
9931target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
9932commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
9933an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
9934process target is active.
c906108c 9935
7a292a7a
SS
9936Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
9937core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify
c906108c 9938files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
7a292a7a
SS
9939the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running
9940process}).
c906108c 9941
6d2ebf8b 9942@node Target Commands
c906108c
SS
9943@section Commands for managing targets
9944
9945@table @code
9946@item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
7a292a7a
SS
9947Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
9948process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
9949facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
9950protocol of the target machine.
c906108c
SS
9951
9952Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
9953typically include things like device names or host names to connect
9954with, process numbers, and baud rates.
c906108c
SS
9955
9956The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
9957after executing the command.
9958
9959@kindex help target
9960@item help target
9961Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
9962currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
9963(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
9964
9965@item help target @var{name}
9966Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
9967select it.
9968
9969@kindex set gnutarget
9970@item set gnutarget @var{args}
5d161b24 9971@value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
c906108c 9972knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
5d161b24
DB
9973a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
9974with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
c906108c
SS
9975with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
9976
d4f3574e 9977@quotation
c906108c
SS
9978@emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
9979you must know the actual BFD name.
d4f3574e 9980@end quotation
c906108c 9981
d4f3574e
SS
9982@noindent
9983@xref{Files, , Commands to specify files}.
c906108c 9984
5d161b24 9985@kindex show gnutarget
c906108c
SS
9986@item show gnutarget
9987Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
9988@code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
9989@value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
9990and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
9991@end table
9992
c906108c
SS
9993Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
9994configuration):
c906108c
SS
9995
9996@table @code
9997@kindex target exec
9998@item target exec @var{program}
9999An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
10000@samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
10001
c906108c
SS
10002@kindex target core
10003@item target core @var{filename}
10004A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
10005@samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
c906108c
SS
10006
10007@kindex target remote
10008@item target remote @var{dev}
10009Remote serial target in GDB-specific protocol. The argument @var{dev}
10010specifies what serial device to use for the connection (e.g.
10011@file{/dev/ttya}). @xref{Remote, ,Remote debugging}. @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 10012supports the @code{load} command. This is only useful if you have
c906108c
SS
10013some other way of getting the stub to the target system, and you can put
10014it somewhere in memory where it won't get clobbered by the download.
10015
c906108c
SS
10016@kindex target sim
10017@item target sim
2df3850c 10018Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
104c1213 10019In general,
474c8240 10020@smallexample
104c1213
JM
10021 target sim
10022 load
10023 run
474c8240 10024@end smallexample
d4f3574e 10025@noindent
104c1213 10026works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
d4f3574e 10027drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
104c1213
JM
10028provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
10029see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
10030Processors}.
10031
c906108c
SS
10032@end table
10033
104c1213 10034Some configurations may include these targets as well:
c906108c
SS
10035
10036@table @code
10037
c906108c
SS
10038@kindex target nrom
10039@item target nrom @var{dev}
10040NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
10041
c906108c
SS
10042@end table
10043
5d161b24 10044Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
c906108c 10045your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
c906108c
SS
10046
10047Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code
10048once you've successfully established a connection.
10049
10050@table @code
10051
10052@kindex load @var{filename}
10053@item load @var{filename}
c906108c
SS
10054Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
10055@value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
10056is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
10057on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
10058@code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
10059the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
10060
10061If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
10062execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
10063target is @dots{}}''
c906108c
SS
10064
10065The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
10066For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
10067link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
10068specifies a fixed address.
10069@c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
10070
c906108c
SS
10071@code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
10072@end table
10073
6d2ebf8b 10074@node Byte Order
c906108c 10075@section Choosing target byte order
7a292a7a 10076
c906108c
SS
10077@cindex choosing target byte order
10078@cindex target byte order
c906108c
SS
10079
10080Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Hitachi SH,
10081offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
10082orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
10083designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
10084which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
d4f3574e 10085@value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
c906108c
SS
10086
10087@table @code
10088@kindex set endian big
10089@item set endian big
10090Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
10091
10092@kindex set endian little
10093@item set endian little
10094Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
10095
10096@kindex set endian auto
10097@item set endian auto
10098Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
10099executable.
10100
10101@item show endian
10102Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
10103
10104@end table
10105
10106Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
10107data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
10108target system.
10109
6d2ebf8b 10110@node Remote
c906108c
SS
10111@section Remote debugging
10112@cindex remote debugging
10113
10114If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
5d161b24
DB
10115@value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
10116For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
c906108c
SS
10117or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
10118powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
10119
10120Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
10121to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
5d161b24 10122@value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
c906108c
SS
10123but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
10124write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
10125communicate with @value{GDBN}.
10126
10127Other remote targets may be available in your
10128configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
c906108c 10129
6f05cf9f
AC
10130@node KOD
10131@section Kernel Object Display
10132
10133@cindex kernel object display
10134@cindex kernel object
10135@cindex KOD
10136
10137Some targets support kernel object display. Using this facility,
10138@value{GDBN} communicates specially with the underlying operating system
10139and can display information about operating system-level objects such as
10140mutexes and other synchronization objects. Exactly which objects can be
10141displayed is determined on a per-OS basis.
10142
10143Use the @code{set os} command to set the operating system. This tells
10144@value{GDBN} which kernel object display module to initialize:
10145
474c8240 10146@smallexample
6f05cf9f 10147(@value{GDBP}) set os cisco
474c8240 10148@end smallexample
6f05cf9f
AC
10149
10150If @code{set os} succeeds, @value{GDBN} will display some information
10151about the operating system, and will create a new @code{info} command
10152which can be used to query the target. The @code{info} command is named
10153after the operating system:
c906108c 10154
474c8240 10155@smallexample
6f05cf9f
AC
10156(@value{GDBP}) info cisco
10157List of Cisco Kernel Objects
10158Object Description
10159any Any and all objects
474c8240 10160@end smallexample
6f05cf9f
AC
10161
10162Further subcommands can be used to query about particular objects known
10163by the kernel.
10164
10165There is currently no way to determine whether a given operating system
10166is supported other than to try it.
10167
10168
10169@node Remote Debugging
10170@chapter Debugging remote programs
10171
6b2f586d
AC
10172@menu
10173* Server:: Using the gdbserver program
10174* NetWare:: Using the gdbserve.nlm program
10175* remote stub:: Implementing a remote stub
6b2f586d
AC
10176@end menu
10177
6f05cf9f
AC
10178@node Server
10179@section Using the @code{gdbserver} program
10180
10181@kindex gdbserver
10182@cindex remote connection without stubs
10183@code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
10184allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10185@code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
10186
10187@code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
10188because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
10189that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
10190@code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
10191@value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
10192because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
10193also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
10194started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
10195Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
10196the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
10197do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
10198by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
10199choice for debugging.
10200
10201@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
10202or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
10203protocol.
10204
10205@table @emph
10206@item On the target machine,
10207you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10208@code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
10209strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
10210system does all the symbol handling.
10211
10212To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
56460a61 10213the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
6f05cf9f
AC
10214syntax is:
10215
10216@smallexample
10217target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10218@end smallexample
10219
10220@var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
10221hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
10222@samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
10223@file{/dev/com1}:
10224
10225@smallexample
10226target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
10227@end smallexample
10228
10229@code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
10230with it.
10231
10232To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
10233
10234@smallexample
10235target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
10236@end smallexample
10237
10238The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
10239specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
10240TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
10241expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
10242(Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
10243you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
10244TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
10245reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
10246conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
10247and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
10248@code{target remote} command.
10249
56460a61
DJ
10250On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
10251This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
10252
10253@smallexample
10254target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach @var{pid}
10255@end smallexample
10256
10257@var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
10258to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
10259
6f05cf9f
AC
10260@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
10261you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
10262symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
10263using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
10264(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
10265running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}.) After that, use @code{target
10266remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserver}. Its argument
10267is either a device name (usually a serial device, like
10268@file{/dev/ttyb}), or a TCP port descriptor in the form
10269@code{@var{host}:@var{PORT}}. For example:
10270
10271@smallexample
10272(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
10273@end smallexample
10274
10275@noindent
10276communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and
10277
10278@smallexample
10279(@value{GDBP}) target remote the-target:2345
10280@end smallexample
10281
10282@noindent
10283communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host @w{@file{the-target}}.
10284For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
10285the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
10286text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
10287@samp{Connection refused}.
10288@end table
10289
10290@node NetWare
10291@section Using the @code{gdbserve.nlm} program
10292
10293@kindex gdbserve.nlm
10294@code{gdbserve.nlm} is a control program for NetWare systems, which
10295allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10296@code{target remote}.
10297
10298@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserve.nlm} communicate via a serial line,
10299using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol.
10300
10301@table @emph
10302@item On the target machine,
10303you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10304@code{gdbserve.nlm} does not need your program's symbol table, so you
10305can strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the
10306host system does all the symbol handling.
10307
10308To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with
10309@value{GDBN}; the name of your program; and the arguments for your
10310program. The syntax is:
10311
10312@smallexample
10313load gdbserve [ BOARD=@var{board} ] [ PORT=@var{port} ]
10314 [ BAUD=@var{baud} ] @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10315@end smallexample
10316
10317@var{board} and @var{port} specify the serial line; @var{baud} specifies
10318the baud rate used by the connection. @var{port} and @var{node} default
10319to 0, @var{baud} defaults to 9600@dmn{bps}.
10320
10321For example, to debug Emacs with the argument @samp{foo.txt}and
10322communicate with @value{GDBN} over serial port number 2 or board 1
10323using a 19200@dmn{bps} connection:
10324
10325@smallexample
10326load gdbserve BOARD=1 PORT=2 BAUD=19200 emacs foo.txt
10327@end smallexample
10328
10329@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
10330you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
10331symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
10332using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
10333(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
10334running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}. After that, use @code{target
10335remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserve.nlm}. Its
10336argument is a device name (usually a serial device, like
10337@file{/dev/ttyb}). For example:
10338
10339@smallexample
10340(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
10341@end smallexample
10342
10343@noindent
10344communications with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}.
10345@end table
10346
10347@node remote stub
10348@section Implementing a remote stub
7a292a7a 10349
8e04817f
AC
10350@cindex debugging stub, example
10351@cindex remote stub, example
10352@cindex stub example, remote debugging
10353The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
10354communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
10355@value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
10356these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
10357implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
10358with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
10359organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
10360
104c1213
JM
10361@cindex remote serial debugging, overview
10362To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
10363@dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
10364prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
10365program, you need:
c906108c 10366
104c1213
JM
10367@enumerate
10368@item
10369A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
10370have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
10371your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
96baa820 10372
5d161b24 10373@item
d4f3574e 10374A C subroutine library to support your program's
104c1213 10375subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
96baa820 10376
104c1213
JM
10377@item
10378A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
10379download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
10380manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
10381documentation.
10382@end enumerate
96baa820 10383
104c1213
JM
10384The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
10385communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
10386machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
96baa820 10387
104c1213
JM
10388@table @emph
10389@item On the host,
10390@value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
10391else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
10392(@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
10393
10394@item On the target,
10395you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
10396implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
10397subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
10398
10399On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
10400@code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
10401@xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} program}, for details.
10402@end table
96baa820 10403
104c1213
JM
10404The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
10405machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
10406@sc{sparc} boards.
96baa820 10407
104c1213
JM
10408@cindex remote serial stub list
10409These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
96baa820 10410
104c1213
JM
10411@table @code
10412
10413@item i386-stub.c
41afff9a 10414@cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10415@cindex Intel
10416@cindex i386
10417For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
10418
10419@item m68k-stub.c
41afff9a 10420@cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10421@cindex Motorola 680x0
10422@cindex m680x0
10423For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
10424
10425@item sh-stub.c
41afff9a 10426@cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10427@cindex Hitachi
10428@cindex SH
10429For Hitachi SH architectures.
10430
10431@item sparc-stub.c
41afff9a 10432@cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10433@cindex Sparc
10434For @sc{sparc} architectures.
10435
10436@item sparcl-stub.c
41afff9a 10437@cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10438@cindex Fujitsu
10439@cindex SparcLite
10440For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
10441
10442@end table
10443
10444The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
10445recently added stubs.
10446
10447@menu
10448* Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
10449* Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
10450* Debug Session:: Putting it all together
104c1213
JM
10451@end menu
10452
6d2ebf8b 10453@node Stub Contents
6f05cf9f 10454@subsection What the stub can do for you
104c1213
JM
10455
10456@cindex remote serial stub
10457The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
10458subroutines:
10459
10460@table @code
10461@item set_debug_traps
10462@kindex set_debug_traps
10463@cindex remote serial stub, initialization
10464This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
10465program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
10466beginning of your program.
10467
10468@item handle_exception
10469@kindex handle_exception
10470@cindex remote serial stub, main routine
10471This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
10472explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
10473run when a trap is triggered.
10474
10475@code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
10476execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
10477with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
10478protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
d4f3574e 10479representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
104c1213
JM
10480information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
10481retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
10482execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
10483@code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
5d161b24 10484machine.
104c1213
JM
10485
10486@item breakpoint
10487@cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
10488Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
10489breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
10490way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
10491machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
10492pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
10493@code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
10494simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
10495again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
10496your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
5d161b24 10497@value{GDBN} session gets control.
104c1213
JM
10498
10499Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
10500to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
10501start of your debugging session.
10502@end table
10503
6d2ebf8b 10504@node Bootstrapping
6f05cf9f 10505@subsection What you must do for the stub
104c1213
JM
10506
10507@cindex remote stub, support routines
10508The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
10509chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
10510debugging target machine.
10511
10512First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
10513serial port.
10514
10515@table @code
10516@item int getDebugChar()
10517@kindex getDebugChar
10518Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
10519It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
10520different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
10521
10522@item void putDebugChar(int)
10523@kindex putDebugChar
10524Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
5d161b24 10525It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
104c1213
JM
10526different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
10527@end table
10528
10529@cindex control C, and remote debugging
10530@cindex interrupting remote targets
10531If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
10532running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
10533for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
10534character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
10535remote system to stop.
10536
10537Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
10538probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
10539is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
10540@value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
10541
10542Other routines you need to supply are:
10543
10544@table @code
10545@item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
10546@kindex exceptionHandler
10547Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
10548handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
10549way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
10550are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
10551containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
10552@var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
10553its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
10554might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
10555exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
10556@var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
10557and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
10558you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
10559should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
10560
10561For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
10562gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
10563should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
10564@sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
10565help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
10566
10567@item void flush_i_cache()
10568@kindex flush_i_cache
d4f3574e 10569On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
104c1213
JM
10570instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
10571instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
10572
10573On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
10574function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
10575@end table
10576
10577@noindent
10578You must also make sure this library routine is available:
10579
10580@table @code
10581@item void *memset(void *, int, int)
10582@kindex memset
10583This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
10584memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
10585@code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
10586either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
10587@end table
10588
10589If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
10590library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
10591but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
d4f3574e 10592subroutines which @code{@value{GCC}} generates as inline code.
104c1213
JM
10593
10594
6d2ebf8b 10595@node Debug Session
6f05cf9f 10596@subsection Putting it all together
104c1213
JM
10597
10598@cindex remote serial debugging summary
10599In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
10600steps.
10601
10602@enumerate
10603@item
6d2ebf8b 10604Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
104c1213
JM
10605(@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What you must do for the stub}):
10606@display
10607@code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
10608@code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
10609@end display
10610
10611@item
10612Insert these lines near the top of your program:
10613
474c8240 10614@smallexample
104c1213
JM
10615set_debug_traps();
10616breakpoint();
474c8240 10617@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
10618
10619@item
10620For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
10621@code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
10622
474c8240 10623@smallexample
104c1213 10624void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
474c8240 10625@end smallexample
104c1213 10626
d4f3574e 10627@noindent
104c1213 10628but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
598ca718 10629function in your program, that function is called when
104c1213
JM
10630@code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
10631error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
10632one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
10633
10634@item
10635Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
10636your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
10637
10638@item
10639Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
10640the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
10641
10642@item
10643@c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
10644@c document that. FIXME.
10645Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
10646whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
10647
10648@item
10649To start remote debugging, run @value{GDBN} on the host machine, and specify
10650as an executable file the program that is running in the remote machine.
10651This tells @value{GDBN} how to find your program's symbols and the contents
10652of its pure text.
10653
d4f3574e 10654@item
104c1213 10655@cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 10656Establish communication using the @code{target remote} command.
104c1213
JM
10657Its argument specifies how to communicate with the target
10658machine---either via a devicename attached to a direct serial line, or a
9db8d71f 10659TCP or UDP port (usually to a terminal server which in turn has a serial line
104c1213
JM
10660to the target). For example, to use a serial line connected to the
10661device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
10662
474c8240 10663@smallexample
104c1213 10664target remote /dev/ttyb
474c8240 10665@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
10666
10667@cindex TCP port, @code{target remote}
10668To use a TCP connection, use an argument of the form
9db8d71f
DJ
10669@code{@var{host}:@var{port}} or @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}.
10670For example, to connect to port 2828 on a
104c1213
JM
10671terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
10672
474c8240 10673@smallexample
104c1213 10674target remote manyfarms:2828
474c8240 10675@end smallexample
a2bea4c3
CV
10676
10677If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as
10678your debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator of your target running on
10679the same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect
10680to port 1234 on your local machine:
10681
474c8240 10682@smallexample
a2bea4c3 10683target remote :1234
474c8240 10684@end smallexample
a2bea4c3
CV
10685@noindent
10686
10687Note that the colon is still required here.
9db8d71f
DJ
10688
10689@cindex UDP port, @code{target remote}
10690To use a UDP connection, use an argument of the form
10691@code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}. For example, to connect to UDP port 2828
10692on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
10693
10694@smallexample
10695target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
10696@end smallexample
10697
10698When using a UDP connection for remote debugging, you should keep in mind
10699that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. UDP can silently drop packets on
10700busy or unreliable networks, which will cause havoc with your debugging
10701session.
10702
104c1213
JM
10703@end enumerate
10704
10705Now you can use all the usual commands to examine and change data and to
10706step and continue the remote program.
10707
10708To resume the remote program and stop debugging it, use the @code{detach}
10709command.
10710
10711@cindex interrupting remote programs
10712@cindex remote programs, interrupting
10713Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
10714interrupt character (often @key{C-C}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
10715program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
10716and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
10717interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
10718
474c8240 10719@smallexample
104c1213
JM
10720Interrupted while waiting for the program.
10721Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
474c8240 10722@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
10723
10724If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
10725(If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
10726remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
10727goes back to waiting.
10728
104c1213 10729
8e04817f
AC
10730@node Configurations
10731@chapter Configuration-Specific Information
104c1213 10732
8e04817f
AC
10733While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
10734cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
10735describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
104c1213 10736
8e04817f
AC
10737There are three major categories of configurations: native
10738configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
10739operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
10740different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
10741are quite different from each other.
104c1213 10742
8e04817f
AC
10743@menu
10744* Native::
10745* Embedded OS::
10746* Embedded Processors::
10747* Architectures::
10748@end menu
104c1213 10749
8e04817f
AC
10750@node Native
10751@section Native
104c1213 10752
8e04817f
AC
10753This section describes details specific to particular native
10754configurations.
6cf7e474 10755
8e04817f
AC
10756@menu
10757* HP-UX:: HP-UX
10758* SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
10759* DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
78c47bea 10760* Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
8e04817f 10761@end menu
6cf7e474 10762
8e04817f
AC
10763@node HP-UX
10764@subsection HP-UX
104c1213 10765
8e04817f
AC
10766On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
10767begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
10768name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
104c1213 10769
8e04817f
AC
10770@node SVR4 Process Information
10771@subsection SVR4 process information
104c1213 10772
8e04817f
AC
10773@kindex /proc
10774@cindex process image
104c1213 10775
8e04817f
AC
10776Many versions of SVR4 provide a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
10777used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
10778subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with
10779this facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report on
10780several kinds of information about the process running your program.
10781@code{info proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the
10782@code{procfs} code. This includes OSF/1 (Digital Unix), Solaris, Irix,
1104b9e7 10783and Unixware, but not HP-UX or @sc{gnu}/Linux, for example.
104c1213 10784
8e04817f
AC
10785@table @code
10786@kindex info proc
10787@item info proc
10788Summarize available information about the process.
6cf7e474 10789
8e04817f
AC
10790@kindex info proc mappings
10791@item info proc mappings
10792Report on the address ranges accessible in the program, with information
10793on whether your program may read, write, or execute each range.
10794@ignore
10795@comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
10796@comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
10797@comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
10798@kindex info proc times
10799@item info proc times
10800Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
10801its children.
6cf7e474 10802
8e04817f
AC
10803@kindex info proc id
10804@item info proc id
10805Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
10806the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
104c1213 10807
8e04817f
AC
10808@kindex info proc status
10809@item info proc status
10810General information on the state of the process. If the process is
10811stopped, this report includes the reason for stopping, and any signal
10812received.
d4f3574e 10813
8e04817f
AC
10814@item info proc all
10815Show all the above information about the process.
10816@end ignore
10817@end table
104c1213 10818
8e04817f
AC
10819@node DJGPP Native
10820@subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
10821@cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
10822@cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
10823@cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
104c1213 10824
8e04817f
AC
10825@sc{djgpp} is the port of @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
10826MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
10827that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
10828top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
104c1213 10829
8e04817f
AC
10830@value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
10831defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
10832subsection describes those commands.
104c1213 10833
8e04817f
AC
10834@table @code
10835@kindex info dos
10836@item info dos
10837This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
10838information about the target system and important OS structures.
f1251bdd 10839
8e04817f
AC
10840@kindex sysinfo
10841@cindex MS-DOS system info
10842@cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
10843@item info dos sysinfo
10844This command displays assorted information about the underlying
10845platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
10846DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
104c1213 10847
8e04817f
AC
10848@cindex GDT
10849@cindex LDT
10850@cindex IDT
10851@cindex segment descriptor tables
10852@cindex descriptor tables display
10853@item info dos gdt
10854@itemx info dos ldt
10855@itemx info dos idt
10856These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
10857and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
10858tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
10859that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
10860descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
10861descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
10862rights.
104c1213 10863
8e04817f
AC
10864A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
10865segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
10866allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
10867conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
10868additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
d4f3574e 10869
8e04817f
AC
10870@cindex garbled pointers
10871These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
10872Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
10873displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
10874display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
10875example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
10876debugged program's data segment:
104c1213 10877
8e04817f
AC
10878@smallexample
10879@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
10880@exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
10881@end smallexample
104c1213 10882
8e04817f
AC
10883@noindent
10884This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
10885the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
104c1213 10886
8e04817f
AC
10887@cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
10888@item info dos pde
10889@itemx info dos pte
10890These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
10891Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
10892data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
10893into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
10894page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
10895may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
10896Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
10897that is currently in use.
104c1213 10898
8e04817f
AC
10899Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
10900Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
10901the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
10902@kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
10903Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
10904means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
10905the specified entry in the Page Directory.
104c1213 10906
8e04817f
AC
10907@cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
10908These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
10909Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
10910controller.
104c1213 10911
8e04817f 10912These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
104c1213 10913
8e04817f
AC
10914@cindex physical address from linear address
10915@item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
10916This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
10917address. The argument linear address @var{addr} should already have the
10918appropriate segment's base address added to it, because this command
10919accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any} segment. For
10920example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for the page where
10921the variable @code{i} is stored:
104c1213 10922
8e04817f
AC
10923@smallexample
10924@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
10925@exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
10926@exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
10927@end smallexample
104c1213 10928
8e04817f
AC
10929@noindent
10930This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
10931whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and prints all the
10932attributes of that page.
104c1213 10933
8e04817f
AC
10934Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
10935since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
10936address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
10937be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
10938declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
10939@code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
104c1213 10940
8e04817f
AC
10941Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
10942transfer buffer:
104c1213 10943
8e04817f
AC
10944@smallexample
10945@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
10946@exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
10947@exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
10948@end smallexample
104c1213 10949
8e04817f
AC
10950@noindent
10951(The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
109523rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output of
10953this command clearly shows that addresses in conventional memory are
10954mapped 1:1, i.e.@: the physical and linear addresses are identical.
104c1213 10955
8e04817f
AC
10956This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
10957@end table
104c1213 10958
78c47bea
PM
10959@node Cygwin Native
10960@subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE executables
10961@cindex MS Windows debugging
10962@cindex native Cygwin debugging
10963@cindex Cygwin-specific commands
10964
10965@value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, and
10966defines a few commands specific to the Cygwin port. This
10967subsection describes those commands.
10968
10969@table @code
10970@kindex info w32
10971@item info w32
10972This is a prefix of MS Windows specific commands which print
10973information about the target system and important OS structures.
10974
10975@item info w32 selector
10976This command displays information returned by
10977the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
10978It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
10979a long value to give the information about this given selector.
10980Without argument, this command displays information
10981about the the six segment registers.
10982
10983@kindex info dll
10984@item info dll
10985This is a Cygwin specific alias of info shared.
10986
10987@kindex dll-symbols
10988@item dll-symbols
10989This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
10990add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
10991
10992@kindex set new-console
10993@item set new-console @var{mode}
10994If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
10995be started in a new console on next start.
10996If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
10997be started in the same console as the debugger.
10998
10999@kindex show new-console
11000@item show new-console
11001Displays whether a new console is used
11002when the debuggee is started.
11003
11004@kindex set new-group
11005@item set new-group @var{mode}
11006This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
11007start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
11008This affects the way the Windows OS handles
11009Ctrl-C.
11010
11011@kindex show new-group
11012@item show new-group
11013Displays current value of new-group boolean.
11014
11015@kindex set debugevents
11016@item set debugevents
11017This boolean value adds debug output concerning events seen by the debugger.
11018
11019@kindex set debugexec
11020@item set debugexec
11021This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
11022seen by the debugger.
11023
11024@kindex set debugexceptions
11025@item set debugexceptions
11026This boolean value adds debug ouptut concerning exception events
11027seen by the debugger.
11028
11029@kindex set debugmemory
11030@item set debugmemory
11031This boolean value adds debug ouptut concerning memory events
11032seen by the debugger.
11033
11034@kindex set shell
11035@item set shell
11036This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
11037via a shell or directly (default value is on).
11038
11039@kindex show shell
11040@item show shell
11041Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
11042
11043@end table
11044
8e04817f
AC
11045@node Embedded OS
11046@section Embedded Operating Systems
104c1213 11047
8e04817f
AC
11048This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
11049embedded operating systems that are available for several different
11050architectures.
d4f3574e 11051
8e04817f
AC
11052@menu
11053* VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
11054@end menu
104c1213 11055
8e04817f
AC
11056@value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
11057various real-time operating systems.
104c1213 11058
8e04817f
AC
11059@node VxWorks
11060@subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
104c1213 11061
8e04817f 11062@cindex VxWorks
104c1213 11063
8e04817f 11064@table @code
104c1213 11065
8e04817f
AC
11066@kindex target vxworks
11067@item target vxworks @var{machinename}
11068A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
11069is the target system's machine name or IP address.
104c1213 11070
8e04817f 11071@end table
104c1213 11072
8e04817f
AC
11073On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
11074current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
104c1213 11075
8e04817f
AC
11076@value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
11077VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
11078the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
11079both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
11080@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
11081installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
11082@value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
104c1213 11083
8e04817f
AC
11084@table @code
11085@item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
11086@kindex vxworks-timeout
11087All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
11088This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
11089seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
11090your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
11091of a thin network line.
11092@end table
104c1213 11093
8e04817f
AC
11094The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
11095this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
11096procedures.
104c1213 11097
8e04817f
AC
11098@kindex INCLUDE_RDB
11099To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
11100to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
11101library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
11102VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
11103kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
11104source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
11105information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
11106manual.
11107@c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
104c1213 11108
8e04817f
AC
11109Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
11110your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
11111run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
11112@code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
104c1213 11113
8e04817f 11114@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
104c1213 11115
474c8240 11116@smallexample
8e04817f 11117(vxgdb)
474c8240 11118@end smallexample
104c1213 11119
8e04817f
AC
11120@menu
11121* VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
11122* VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
11123* VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
11124@end menu
104c1213 11125
8e04817f
AC
11126@node VxWorks Connection
11127@subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
104c1213 11128
8e04817f
AC
11129The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
11130network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
104c1213 11131
474c8240 11132@smallexample
8e04817f 11133(vxgdb) target vxworks tt
474c8240 11134@end smallexample
104c1213 11135
8e04817f
AC
11136@need 750
11137@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
104c1213 11138
8e04817f
AC
11139@smallexample
11140Attaching remote machine across net...
11141Connected to tt.
11142@end smallexample
104c1213 11143
8e04817f
AC
11144@need 1000
11145@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
11146loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
11147these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
11148path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}); if it fails
11149to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
5d161b24 11150
474c8240 11151@smallexample
8e04817f 11152prog.o: No such file or directory.
474c8240 11153@end smallexample
104c1213 11154
8e04817f
AC
11155When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
11156the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
11157command again.
104c1213 11158
8e04817f
AC
11159@node VxWorks Download
11160@subsubsection VxWorks download
104c1213 11161
8e04817f
AC
11162@cindex download to VxWorks
11163If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
11164object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
11165@code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
11166incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
11167command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
11168to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
11169table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
11170the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
11171filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
11172Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
11173to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
11174the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
11175@file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
11176and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
11177program, type this on VxWorks:
104c1213 11178
474c8240 11179@smallexample
8e04817f 11180-> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
474c8240 11181@end smallexample
104c1213 11182
8e04817f
AC
11183@noindent
11184Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
104c1213 11185
474c8240 11186@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11187(vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
11188(vxgdb) load prog.o
474c8240 11189@end smallexample
104c1213 11190
8e04817f 11191@value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
104c1213 11192
8e04817f
AC
11193@smallexample
11194Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
11195@end smallexample
104c1213 11196
8e04817f
AC
11197You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
11198after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
11199this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
11200auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
11201history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
11202debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
11203table.)
104c1213 11204
8e04817f
AC
11205@node VxWorks Attach
11206@subsubsection Running tasks
104c1213
JM
11207
11208@cindex running VxWorks tasks
11209You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
11210follows:
11211
474c8240 11212@smallexample
104c1213 11213(vxgdb) attach @var{task}
474c8240 11214@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
11215
11216@noindent
11217where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
11218or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
11219the time of attachment.
11220
6d2ebf8b 11221@node Embedded Processors
104c1213
JM
11222@section Embedded Processors
11223
11224This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
11225configurations.
11226
7d86b5d5 11227
104c1213 11228@menu
104c1213
JM
11229* ARM:: ARM
11230* H8/300:: Hitachi H8/300
11231* H8/500:: Hitachi H8/500
11232* i960:: Intel i960
11233* M32R/D:: Mitsubishi M32R/D
11234* M68K:: Motorola M68K
104c1213 11235* MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
a37295f9 11236* OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
104c1213
JM
11237* PA:: HP PA Embedded
11238* PowerPC: PowerPC
11239* SH:: Hitachi SH
11240* Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
11241* Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
11242* ST2000:: Tandem ST2000
11243* Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
11244@end menu
11245
6d2ebf8b 11246@node ARM
104c1213
JM
11247@subsection ARM
11248
11249@table @code
11250
8e04817f
AC
11251@kindex target rdi
11252@item target rdi @var{dev}
11253ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
11254use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
11255monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
11256
11257@kindex target rdp
11258@item target rdp @var{dev}
11259ARM Demon monitor.
11260
11261@end table
11262
11263@node H8/300
11264@subsection Hitachi H8/300
11265
11266@table @code
11267
11268@kindex target hms@r{, with H8/300}
11269@item target hms @var{dev}
11270A Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500 board, attached via serial line to your host.
11271Use special commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial
11272line and the communications speed used.
11273
11274@kindex target e7000@r{, with H8/300}
11275@item target e7000 @var{dev}
11276E7000 emulator for Hitachi H8 and SH.
11277
11278@kindex target sh3@r{, with H8/300}
11279@kindex target sh3e@r{, with H8/300}
11280@item target sh3 @var{dev}
11281@itemx target sh3e @var{dev}
11282Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
11283
11284@end table
11285
11286@cindex download to H8/300 or H8/500
11287@cindex H8/300 or H8/500 download
11288@cindex download to Hitachi SH
11289@cindex Hitachi SH download
11290When you select remote debugging to a Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500
11291board, the @code{load} command downloads your program to the Hitachi
11292board and also opens it as the current executable target for
11293@value{GDBN} on your host (like the @code{file} command).
11294
11295@value{GDBN} needs to know these things to talk to your
11296Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500:
11297
11298@enumerate
11299@item
11300that you want to use @samp{target hms}, the remote debugging interface
11301for Hitachi microprocessors, or @samp{target e7000}, the in-circuit
11302emulator for the Hitachi SH and the Hitachi 300H. (@samp{target hms} is
11303the default when @value{GDBN} is configured specifically for the Hitachi SH,
11304H8/300, or H8/500.)
11305
11306@item
11307what serial device connects your host to your Hitachi board (the first
11308serial device available on your host is the default).
11309
11310@item
11311what speed to use over the serial device.
11312@end enumerate
11313
11314@menu
11315* Hitachi Boards:: Connecting to Hitachi boards.
11316* Hitachi ICE:: Using the E7000 In-Circuit Emulator.
11317* Hitachi Special:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros.
11318@end menu
11319
11320@node Hitachi Boards
11321@subsubsection Connecting to Hitachi boards
11322
11323@c only for Unix hosts
11324@kindex device
11325@cindex serial device, Hitachi micros
11326Use the special @code{@value{GDBN}} command @samp{device @var{port}} if you
11327need to explicitly set the serial device. The default @var{port} is the
11328first available port on your host. This is only necessary on Unix
11329hosts, where it is typically something like @file{/dev/ttya}.
11330
11331@kindex speed
11332@cindex serial line speed, Hitachi micros
11333@code{@value{GDBN}} has another special command to set the communications
11334speed: @samp{speed @var{bps}}. This command also is only used from Unix
11335hosts; on DOS hosts, set the line speed as usual from outside @value{GDBN} with
11336the DOS @code{mode} command (for instance,
11337@w{@kbd{mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p}} for a 9600@dmn{bps} connection).
11338
11339The @samp{device} and @samp{speed} commands are available only when you
11340use a Unix host to debug your Hitachi microprocessor programs. If you
11341use a DOS host,
11342@value{GDBN} depends on an auxiliary terminate-and-stay-resident program
11343called @code{asynctsr} to communicate with the development board
11344through a PC serial port. You must also use the DOS @code{mode} command
11345to set up the serial port on the DOS side.
11346
11347The following sample session illustrates the steps needed to start a
11348program under @value{GDBN} control on an H8/300. The example uses a
11349sample H8/300 program called @file{t.x}. The procedure is the same for
11350the Hitachi SH and the H8/500.
11351
11352First hook up your development board. In this example, we use a
11353board attached to serial port @code{COM2}; if you use a different serial
11354port, substitute its name in the argument of the @code{mode} command.
11355When you call @code{asynctsr}, the auxiliary comms program used by the
11356debugger, you give it just the numeric part of the serial port's name;
11357for example, @samp{asyncstr 2} below runs @code{asyncstr} on
11358@code{COM2}.
11359
474c8240 11360@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11361C:\H8300\TEST> asynctsr 2
11362C:\H8300\TEST> mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p
11363
11364Resident portion of MODE loaded
11365
11366COM2: 9600, n, 8, 1, p
11367
474c8240 11368@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11369
11370@quotation
11371@emph{Warning:} We have noticed a bug in PC-NFS that conflicts with
11372@code{asynctsr}. If you also run PC-NFS on your DOS host, you may need to
11373disable it, or even boot without it, to use @code{asynctsr} to control
11374your development board.
11375@end quotation
11376
11377@kindex target hms@r{, and serial protocol}
11378Now that serial communications are set up, and the development board is
11379connected, you can start up @value{GDBN}. Call @code{@value{GDBP}} with
11380the name of your program as the argument. @code{@value{GDBN}} prompts
11381you, as usual, with the prompt @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. Use two special
11382commands to begin your debugging session: @samp{target hms} to specify
11383cross-debugging to the Hitachi board, and the @code{load} command to
11384download your program to the board. @code{load} displays the names of
11385the program's sections, and a @samp{*} for each 2K of data downloaded.
11386(If you want to refresh @value{GDBN} data on symbols or on the
11387executable file without downloading, use the @value{GDBN} commands
11388@code{file} or @code{symbol-file}. These commands, and @code{load}
11389itself, are described in @ref{Files,,Commands to specify files}.)
11390
11391@smallexample
11392(eg-C:\H8300\TEST) @value{GDBP} t.x
11393@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
11394 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
11395 the conditions.
11396There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
11397for details.
11398@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
11399(@value{GDBP}) target hms
11400Connected to remote H8/300 HMS system.
11401(@value{GDBP}) load t.x
11402.text : 0x8000 .. 0xabde ***********
11403.data : 0xabde .. 0xad30 *
11404.stack : 0xf000 .. 0xf014 *
11405@end smallexample
11406
11407At this point, you're ready to run or debug your program. From here on,
11408you can use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands. The @code{break} command
11409sets breakpoints; the @code{run} command starts your program;
11410@code{print} or @code{x} display data; the @code{continue} command
11411resumes execution after stopping at a breakpoint. You can use the
11412@code{help} command at any time to find out more about @value{GDBN} commands.
11413
11414Remember, however, that @emph{operating system} facilities aren't
11415available on your development board; for example, if your program hangs,
11416you can't send an interrupt---but you can press the @sc{reset} switch!
11417
11418Use the @sc{reset} button on the development board
11419@itemize @bullet
11420@item
11421to interrupt your program (don't use @kbd{ctl-C} on the DOS host---it has
11422no way to pass an interrupt signal to the development board); and
11423
11424@item
11425to return to the @value{GDBN} command prompt after your program finishes
11426normally. The communications protocol provides no other way for @value{GDBN}
11427to detect program completion.
11428@end itemize
11429
11430In either case, @value{GDBN} sees the effect of a @sc{reset} on the
11431development board as a ``normal exit'' of your program.
11432
11433@node Hitachi ICE
11434@subsubsection Using the E7000 in-circuit emulator
11435
11436@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi ICE}
11437You can use the E7000 in-circuit emulator to develop code for either the
11438Hitachi SH or the H8/300H. Use one of these forms of the @samp{target
11439e7000} command to connect @value{GDBN} to your E7000:
11440
11441@table @code
11442@item target e7000 @var{port} @var{speed}
11443Use this form if your E7000 is connected to a serial port. The
11444@var{port} argument identifies what serial port to use (for example,
11445@samp{com2}). The third argument is the line speed in bits per second
11446(for example, @samp{9600}).
11447
11448@item target e7000 @var{hostname}
11449If your E7000 is installed as a host on a TCP/IP network, you can just
11450specify its hostname; @value{GDBN} uses @code{telnet} to connect.
11451@end table
11452
11453@node Hitachi Special
11454@subsubsection Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros
11455
11456Some @value{GDBN} commands are available only for the H8/300:
11457
11458@table @code
11459
11460@kindex set machine
11461@kindex show machine
11462@item set machine h8300
11463@itemx set machine h8300h
11464Condition @value{GDBN} for one of the two variants of the H8/300
11465architecture with @samp{set machine}. You can use @samp{show machine}
11466to check which variant is currently in effect.
104c1213
JM
11467
11468@end table
11469
8e04817f
AC
11470@node H8/500
11471@subsection H8/500
104c1213
JM
11472
11473@table @code
11474
8e04817f
AC
11475@kindex set memory @var{mod}
11476@cindex memory models, H8/500
11477@item set memory @var{mod}
11478@itemx show memory
11479Specify which H8/500 memory model (@var{mod}) you are using with
11480@samp{set memory}; check which memory model is in effect with @samp{show
11481memory}. The accepted values for @var{mod} are @code{small},
11482@code{big}, @code{medium}, and @code{compact}.
104c1213 11483
8e04817f 11484@end table
104c1213 11485
8e04817f
AC
11486@node i960
11487@subsection Intel i960
104c1213 11488
8e04817f 11489@table @code
104c1213 11490
8e04817f
AC
11491@kindex target mon960
11492@item target mon960 @var{dev}
11493MON960 monitor for Intel i960.
104c1213 11494
8e04817f
AC
11495@kindex target nindy
11496@item target nindy @var{devicename}
11497An Intel 960 board controlled by a Nindy Monitor. @var{devicename} is
11498the name of the serial device to use for the connection, e.g.
11499@file{/dev/ttya}.
104c1213 11500
8e04817f
AC
11501@end table
11502
11503@cindex Nindy
11504@cindex i960
11505@dfn{Nindy} is a ROM Monitor program for Intel 960 target systems. When
11506@value{GDBN} is configured to control a remote Intel 960 using Nindy, you can
11507tell @value{GDBN} how to connect to the 960 in several ways:
11508
11509@itemize @bullet
104c1213 11510@item
8e04817f
AC
11511Through command line options specifying serial port, version of the
11512Nindy protocol, and communications speed;
104c1213
JM
11513
11514@item
8e04817f 11515By responding to a prompt on startup;
104c1213
JM
11516
11517@item
8e04817f
AC
11518By using the @code{target} command at any point during your @value{GDBN}
11519session. @xref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}.
11520
11521@end itemize
11522
11523@cindex download to Nindy-960
11524With the Nindy interface to an Intel 960 board, @code{load}
11525downloads @var{filename} to the 960 as well as adding its symbols in
11526@value{GDBN}.
11527
11528@menu
11529* Nindy Startup:: Startup with Nindy
11530* Nindy Options:: Options for Nindy
11531* Nindy Reset:: Nindy reset command
11532@end menu
11533
11534@node Nindy Startup
11535@subsubsection Startup with Nindy
11536
11537If you simply start @code{@value{GDBP}} without using any command-line
11538options, you are prompted for what serial port to use, @emph{before} you
11539reach the ordinary @value{GDBN} prompt:
11540
474c8240 11541@smallexample
8e04817f 11542Attach /dev/ttyNN -- specify NN, or "quit" to quit:
474c8240 11543@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11544
11545@noindent
11546Respond to the prompt with whatever suffix (after @samp{/dev/tty})
11547identifies the serial port you want to use. You can, if you choose,
11548simply start up with no Nindy connection by responding to the prompt
11549with an empty line. If you do this and later wish to attach to Nindy,
11550use @code{target} (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
11551
11552@node Nindy Options
11553@subsubsection Options for Nindy
11554
11555These are the startup options for beginning your @value{GDBN} session with a
11556Nindy-960 board attached:
11557
11558@table @code
11559@item -r @var{port}
11560Specify the serial port name of a serial interface to be used to connect
11561to the target system. This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is
11562configured for the Intel 960 target architecture. You may specify
11563@var{port} as any of: a full pathname (e.g. @samp{-r /dev/ttya}), a
11564device name in @file{/dev} (e.g. @samp{-r ttya}), or simply the unique
11565suffix for a specific @code{tty} (e.g. @samp{-r a}).
11566
11567@item -O
11568(An uppercase letter ``O'', not a zero.) Specify that @value{GDBN} should use
11569the ``old'' Nindy monitor protocol to connect to the target system.
11570This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is configured for the Intel 960
11571target architecture.
11572
11573@quotation
11574@emph{Warning:} if you specify @samp{-O}, but are actually trying to
11575connect to a target system that expects the newer protocol, the connection
11576fails, appearing to be a speed mismatch. @value{GDBN} repeatedly
11577attempts to reconnect at several different line speeds. You can abort
11578this process with an interrupt.
11579@end quotation
11580
11581@item -brk
11582Specify that @value{GDBN} should first send a @code{BREAK} signal to the target
11583system, in an attempt to reset it, before connecting to a Nindy target.
11584
11585@quotation
11586@emph{Warning:} Many target systems do not have the hardware that this
11587requires; it only works with a few boards.
11588@end quotation
11589@end table
11590
11591The standard @samp{-b} option controls the line speed used on the serial
11592port.
11593
11594@c @group
11595@node Nindy Reset
11596@subsubsection Nindy reset command
11597
11598@table @code
11599@item reset
11600@kindex reset
11601For a Nindy target, this command sends a ``break'' to the remote target
11602system; this is only useful if the target has been equipped with a
11603circuit to perform a hard reset (or some other interesting action) when
11604a break is detected.
11605@end table
11606@c @end group
11607
11608@node M32R/D
11609@subsection Mitsubishi M32R/D
11610
11611@table @code
11612
11613@kindex target m32r
11614@item target m32r @var{dev}
11615Mitsubishi M32R/D ROM monitor.
11616
11617@end table
11618
11619@node M68K
11620@subsection M68k
11621
11622The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and
11623target command for the following ROM monitors.
11624
11625@table @code
11626
11627@kindex target abug
11628@item target abug @var{dev}
11629ABug ROM monitor for M68K.
11630
11631@kindex target cpu32bug
11632@item target cpu32bug @var{dev}
11633CPU32BUG monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
11634
11635@kindex target dbug
11636@item target dbug @var{dev}
11637dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
11638
11639@kindex target est
11640@item target est @var{dev}
11641EST-300 ICE monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
11642
11643@kindex target rom68k
11644@item target rom68k @var{dev}
11645ROM 68K monitor, running on an M68K IDP board.
11646
11647@end table
11648
11649If @value{GDBN} is configured with @code{m68*-ericsson-*}, it will
11650instead have only a single special target command:
11651
11652@table @code
11653
11654@kindex target es1800
11655@item target es1800 @var{dev}
11656ES-1800 emulator for M68K.
11657
11658@end table
11659
11660[context?]
11661
11662@table @code
11663
11664@kindex target rombug
11665@item target rombug @var{dev}
11666ROMBUG ROM monitor for OS/9000.
11667
11668@end table
11669
8e04817f
AC
11670@node MIPS Embedded
11671@subsection MIPS Embedded
11672
11673@cindex MIPS boards
11674@value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
11675MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
11676you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
104c1213 11677
8e04817f
AC
11678@need 1000
11679Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
104c1213 11680
8e04817f
AC
11681@table @code
11682@item target mips @var{port}
11683@kindex target mips @var{port}
11684To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
11685name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
11686command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
11687the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
11688been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
11689download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
104c1213 11690
8e04817f
AC
11691For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
11692port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
11693debugger:
104c1213 11694
474c8240 11695@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11696host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
11697@value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
11698(@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
11699(@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
11700(@value{GDBP}) run
474c8240 11701@end smallexample
104c1213 11702
8e04817f
AC
11703@item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
11704On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
11705connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
11706concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
11707@samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
104c1213 11708
8e04817f
AC
11709@item target pmon @var{port}
11710@kindex target pmon @var{port}
11711PMON ROM monitor.
104c1213 11712
8e04817f
AC
11713@item target ddb @var{port}
11714@kindex target ddb @var{port}
11715NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
104c1213 11716
8e04817f
AC
11717@item target lsi @var{port}
11718@kindex target lsi @var{port}
11719LSI variant of PMON.
104c1213 11720
8e04817f
AC
11721@kindex target r3900
11722@item target r3900 @var{dev}
11723Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
104c1213 11724
8e04817f
AC
11725@kindex target array
11726@item target array @var{dev}
11727Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
104c1213 11728
8e04817f 11729@end table
104c1213 11730
104c1213 11731
8e04817f
AC
11732@noindent
11733@value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
104c1213 11734
8e04817f
AC
11735@table @code
11736@item set processor @var{args}
11737@itemx show processor
11738@kindex set processor @var{args}
11739@kindex show processor
11740Use the @code{set processor} command to set the type of MIPS
11741processor when you want to access processor-type-specific registers.
11742For example, @code{set processor @var{r3041}} tells @value{GDBN}
11743to use the CPU registers appropriate for the 3041 chip.
11744Use the @code{show processor} command to see what MIPS processor @value{GDBN}
11745is using. Use the @code{info reg} command to see what registers
11746@value{GDBN} is using.
104c1213 11747
8e04817f
AC
11748@item set mipsfpu double
11749@itemx set mipsfpu single
11750@itemx set mipsfpu none
11751@itemx show mipsfpu
11752@kindex set mipsfpu
11753@kindex show mipsfpu
11754@cindex MIPS remote floating point
11755@cindex floating point, MIPS remote
11756If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
11757coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
11758need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
11759file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
11760functions which return floating point values. It also allows
11761@value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
11762functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
11763with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
11764processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
11765double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
11766@samp{set mipsfpu double}.
104c1213 11767
8e04817f
AC
11768In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
11769floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
11770and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
104c1213 11771
8e04817f
AC
11772As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
11773@samp{show mipsfpu}.
104c1213 11774
8e04817f
AC
11775@item set remotedebug @var{n}
11776@itemx show remotedebug
11777@kindex set remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
11778@kindex show remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
11779@cindex @code{remotedebug}, MIPS protocol
11780@cindex MIPS @code{remotedebug} protocol
11781@c FIXME! For this to be useful, you must know something about the MIPS
11782@c FIXME...protocol. Where is it described?
11783You can see some debugging information about communications with the board
11784by setting the @code{remotedebug} variable. If you set it to @code{1} using
11785@samp{set remotedebug 1}, every packet is displayed. If you set it
11786to @code{2}, every character is displayed. You can check the current value
11787at any time with the command @samp{show remotedebug}.
104c1213 11788
8e04817f
AC
11789@item set timeout @var{seconds}
11790@itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
11791@itemx show timeout
11792@itemx show retransmit-timeout
11793@cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
11794@cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
11795@kindex set timeout
11796@kindex show timeout
11797@kindex set retransmit-timeout
11798@kindex show retransmit-timeout
11799You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
11800remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
11801default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
11802waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
11803retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
11804You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
11805retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
11806@value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
104c1213 11807
8e04817f
AC
11808The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
11809is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
11810forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
11811to run before stopping.
11812@end table
104c1213 11813
a37295f9
MM
11814@node OpenRISC 1000
11815@subsection OpenRISC 1000
11816@cindex OpenRISC 1000
11817
11818@cindex or1k boards
11819See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
11820about platform and commands.
11821
11822@table @code
11823
11824@kindex target jtag
11825@item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
11826
11827Connects to remote JTAG server.
11828JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
11829connected via parallel port to the board.
11830
11831Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
11832
11833@kindex or1ksim
11834@item or1ksim @var{command}
11835If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
11836Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
11837
11838@kindex info or1k spr
11839@item info or1k spr
11840Displays spr groups.
11841
11842@item info or1k spr @var{group}
11843@itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
11844Displays register names in selected group.
11845
11846@item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
11847@itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
11848@itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
11849@itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
11850Shows information about specified spr register.
11851
11852@kindex spr
11853@item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
11854@itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
11855@itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
11856@itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
11857Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
11858@end table
11859
11860Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
11861It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
11862program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
11863triggers can be set using:
11864@table @code
11865@item $LEA/$LDATA
11866Load effective address/data
11867@item $SEA/$SDATA
11868Store effective address/data
11869@item $AEA/$ADATA
11870Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
11871@item $FETCH
11872Fetch data
11873@end table
11874
11875When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
11876@code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
11877
11878@code{htrace} commands:
11879@cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
11880@table @code
11881@kindex hwatch
11882@item hwatch @var{conditional}
11883Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effecive Address(es)
11884or Data. For example:
11885
11886@code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
11887
11888@code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
11889
11890@kindex htrace info
11891@item htrace info
11892Display information about current HW trace configuration.
11893
11894@kindex htrace trigger
11895@item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
11896Set starting criteria for HW trace.
11897
11898@kindex htrace qualifier
11899@item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
11900Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
11901
11902@kindex htrace stop
11903@item htrace stop @var{conditional}
11904Set HW trace stopping criteria.
11905
11906@kindex htrace record
11907@item htrace record @var{[data]*}
11908Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
11909triggered.
11910
11911@kindex htrace enable
11912@item htrace enable
11913@kindex htrace disable
11914@itemx htrace disable
11915Enables/disables the HW trace.
11916
11917@kindex htrace rewind
11918@item htrace rewind @var{[filename]}
11919Clears currently recorded trace data.
11920
11921If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
11922will be written there.
11923
11924@kindex htrace print
11925@item htrace print @var{[start [len]]}
11926Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
11927
11928@kindex htrace mode continuous
11929@item htrace mode continuous
11930Set continuous trace mode.
11931
11932@kindex htrace mode suspend
11933@item htrace mode suspend
11934Set suspend trace mode.
11935
11936@end table
11937
8e04817f
AC
11938@node PowerPC
11939@subsection PowerPC
104c1213
JM
11940
11941@table @code
104c1213 11942
8e04817f
AC
11943@kindex target dink32
11944@item target dink32 @var{dev}
11945DINK32 ROM monitor.
104c1213 11946
8e04817f
AC
11947@kindex target ppcbug
11948@item target ppcbug @var{dev}
11949@kindex target ppcbug1
11950@item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
11951PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
104c1213 11952
8e04817f
AC
11953@kindex target sds
11954@item target sds @var{dev}
11955SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
11956
11957@end table
11958
11959@node PA
11960@subsection HP PA Embedded
104c1213
JM
11961
11962@table @code
11963
8e04817f
AC
11964@kindex target op50n
11965@item target op50n @var{dev}
11966OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
11967
11968@kindex target w89k
11969@item target w89k @var{dev}
11970W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
104c1213
JM
11971
11972@end table
11973
8e04817f
AC
11974@node SH
11975@subsection Hitachi SH
104c1213
JM
11976
11977@table @code
11978
8e04817f
AC
11979@kindex target hms@r{, with Hitachi SH}
11980@item target hms @var{dev}
11981A Hitachi SH board attached via serial line to your host. Use special
11982commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial line and
11983the communications speed used.
104c1213 11984
8e04817f
AC
11985@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi SH}
11986@item target e7000 @var{dev}
11987E7000 emulator for Hitachi SH.
104c1213 11988
8e04817f
AC
11989@kindex target sh3@r{, with SH}
11990@kindex target sh3e@r{, with SH}
11991@item target sh3 @var{dev}
11992@item target sh3e @var{dev}
11993Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
104c1213 11994
8e04817f 11995@end table
104c1213 11996
8e04817f
AC
11997@node Sparclet
11998@subsection Tsqware Sparclet
104c1213 11999
8e04817f
AC
12000@cindex Sparclet
12001
12002@value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
12003Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
12004@value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
12005both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
12006@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
104c1213 12007
8e04817f
AC
12008@table @code
12009@item remotetimeout @var{args}
12010@kindex remotetimeout
12011@value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
12012This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
12013seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
104c1213
JM
12014@end table
12015
8e04817f
AC
12016@cindex compiling, on Sparclet
12017When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
12018information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
12019load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
12020@samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
104c1213 12021
474c8240 12022@smallexample
8e04817f 12023sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
474c8240 12024@end smallexample
104c1213 12025
8e04817f 12026You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
104c1213 12027
474c8240 12028@smallexample
8e04817f 12029sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
474c8240 12030@end smallexample
104c1213 12031
8e04817f
AC
12032@cindex running, on Sparclet
12033Once you have set
12034your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
12035run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
12036(or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
104c1213 12037
8e04817f
AC
12038@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
12039
474c8240 12040@smallexample
8e04817f 12041(gdbslet)
474c8240 12042@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
12043
12044@menu
8e04817f
AC
12045* Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
12046* Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
12047* Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
12048* Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
104c1213
JM
12049@end menu
12050
8e04817f
AC
12051@node Sparclet File
12052@subsubsection Setting file to debug
104c1213 12053
8e04817f 12054The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
104c1213 12055
474c8240 12056@smallexample
8e04817f 12057(gdbslet) file prog
474c8240 12058@end smallexample
104c1213 12059
8e04817f
AC
12060@need 1000
12061@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
12062@value{GDBN} locates
12063the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
12064path.
12065If the file was compiled with debug information (option "-g"), source
12066files will be searched as well.
12067@value{GDBN} locates
12068the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
12069path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}).
12070If it fails
12071to find a file, it displays a message such as:
104c1213 12072
474c8240 12073@smallexample
8e04817f 12074prog: No such file or directory.
474c8240 12075@end smallexample
104c1213 12076
8e04817f
AC
12077When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
12078the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
12079@code{target} command again.
104c1213 12080
8e04817f
AC
12081@node Sparclet Connection
12082@subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
104c1213 12083
8e04817f
AC
12084The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
12085To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
104c1213 12086
474c8240 12087@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12088(gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
12089Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
12090main () at ../prog.c:3
474c8240 12091@end smallexample
104c1213 12092
8e04817f
AC
12093@need 750
12094@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
104c1213 12095
474c8240 12096@smallexample
8e04817f 12097Connected to ttya.
474c8240 12098@end smallexample
104c1213 12099
8e04817f
AC
12100@node Sparclet Download
12101@subsubsection Sparclet download
104c1213 12102
8e04817f
AC
12103@cindex download to Sparclet
12104Once connected to the Sparclet target,
12105you can use the @value{GDBN}
12106@code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
12107The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
12108command.
12109Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
12110address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
12111offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
12112of each of the file's sections.
12113For instance, if the program
12114@file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
12115and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
104c1213 12116
474c8240 12117@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12118(gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
12119Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
474c8240 12120@end smallexample
104c1213 12121
8e04817f
AC
12122If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
12123to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
12124to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
12125
12126@node Sparclet Execution
12127@subsubsection Running and debugging
12128
12129@cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
12130You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
12131commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
12132manual for the list of commands.
12133
474c8240 12134@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12135(gdbslet) b main
12136Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
12137(gdbslet) run
12138Starting program: prog
12139Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
121403 char *symarg = 0;
12141(gdbslet) step
121424 char *execarg = "hello!";
12143(gdbslet)
474c8240 12144@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12145
12146@node Sparclite
12147@subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
104c1213
JM
12148
12149@table @code
12150
8e04817f
AC
12151@kindex target sparclite
12152@item target sparclite @var{dev}
12153Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
12154You must use an additional command to debug the program.
12155For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
12156remote protocol.
104c1213
JM
12157
12158@end table
12159
8e04817f
AC
12160@node ST2000
12161@subsection Tandem ST2000
104c1213 12162
8e04817f
AC
12163@value{GDBN} may be used with a Tandem ST2000 phone switch, running Tandem's
12164STDBUG protocol.
104c1213 12165
8e04817f
AC
12166To connect your ST2000 to the host system, see the manufacturer's
12167manual. Once the ST2000 is physically attached, you can run:
104c1213 12168
474c8240 12169@smallexample
8e04817f 12170target st2000 @var{dev} @var{speed}
474c8240 12171@end smallexample
104c1213 12172
8e04817f
AC
12173@noindent
12174to establish it as your debugging environment. @var{dev} is normally
12175the name of a serial device, such as @file{/dev/ttya}, connected to the
12176ST2000 via a serial line. You can instead specify @var{dev} as a TCP
12177connection (for example, to a serial line attached via a terminal
12178concentrator) using the syntax @code{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
104c1213 12179
8e04817f
AC
12180The @code{load} and @code{attach} commands are @emph{not} defined for
12181this target; you must load your program into the ST2000 as you normally
12182would for standalone operation. @value{GDBN} reads debugging information
12183(such as symbols) from a separate, debugging version of the program
12184available on your host computer.
12185@c FIXME!! This is terribly vague; what little content is here is
12186@c basically hearsay.
104c1213 12187
8e04817f
AC
12188@cindex ST2000 auxiliary commands
12189These auxiliary @value{GDBN} commands are available to help you with the ST2000
12190environment:
104c1213 12191
8e04817f
AC
12192@table @code
12193@item st2000 @var{command}
12194@kindex st2000 @var{cmd}
12195@cindex STDBUG commands (ST2000)
12196@cindex commands to STDBUG (ST2000)
12197Send a @var{command} to the STDBUG monitor. See the manufacturer's
12198manual for available commands.
104c1213 12199
8e04817f
AC
12200@item connect
12201@cindex connect (to STDBUG)
12202Connect the controlling terminal to the STDBUG command monitor. When
12203you are done interacting with STDBUG, typing either of two character
12204sequences gets you back to the @value{GDBN} command prompt:
12205@kbd{@key{RET}~.} (Return, followed by tilde and period) or
12206@kbd{@key{RET}~@key{C-d}} (Return, followed by tilde and control-D).
104c1213
JM
12207@end table
12208
8e04817f
AC
12209@node Z8000
12210@subsection Zilog Z8000
104c1213 12211
8e04817f
AC
12212@cindex Z8000
12213@cindex simulator, Z8000
12214@cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
104c1213 12215
8e04817f
AC
12216When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
12217a Z8000 simulator.
12218
12219For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
12220unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
12221segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
12222appropriate by inspecting the object code.
104c1213 12223
8e04817f
AC
12224@table @code
12225@item target sim @var{args}
12226@kindex sim
12227@kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
12228Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
12229options, specify them via @var{args}.
104c1213
JM
12230@end table
12231
8e04817f
AC
12232@noindent
12233After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
12234CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
12235@code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
12236to run your program, and so on.
12237
12238As well as making available all the usual machine registers
12239(@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
12240additional items of information as specially named registers:
104c1213
JM
12241
12242@table @code
12243
8e04817f
AC
12244@item cycles
12245Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
104c1213 12246
8e04817f
AC
12247@item insts
12248Counts instructions run in the simulator.
104c1213 12249
8e04817f
AC
12250@item time
12251Execution time in 60ths of a second.
104c1213 12252
8e04817f 12253@end table
104c1213 12254
8e04817f
AC
12255You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
12256conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
12257conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
12258simulated clock ticks.
104c1213 12259
8e04817f
AC
12260@node Architectures
12261@section Architectures
104c1213 12262
8e04817f
AC
12263This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
12264all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
104c1213 12265
8e04817f
AC
12266@menu
12267* A29K::
12268* Alpha::
12269* MIPS::
12270@end menu
104c1213 12271
8e04817f
AC
12272@node A29K
12273@subsection A29K
104c1213
JM
12274
12275@table @code
104c1213 12276
8e04817f
AC
12277@kindex set rstack_high_address
12278@cindex AMD 29K register stack
12279@cindex register stack, AMD29K
12280@item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
12281On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
12282@dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
12283extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
12284stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
12285memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
12286this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
12287the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
12288address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
12289hexadecimal.
104c1213 12290
8e04817f
AC
12291@kindex show rstack_high_address
12292@item show rstack_high_address
12293Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
12294processors.
104c1213 12295
8e04817f 12296@end table
104c1213 12297
8e04817f
AC
12298@node Alpha
12299@subsection Alpha
104c1213 12300
8e04817f 12301See the following section.
104c1213 12302
8e04817f
AC
12303@node MIPS
12304@subsection MIPS
104c1213 12305
8e04817f
AC
12306@cindex stack on Alpha
12307@cindex stack on MIPS
12308@cindex Alpha stack
12309@cindex MIPS stack
12310Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
12311sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
12312find the beginning of a function.
104c1213 12313
8e04817f
AC
12314@cindex response time, MIPS debugging
12315To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
12316@value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
12317you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
12318commands:
104c1213 12319
8e04817f
AC
12320@table @code
12321@cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
12322@item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
12323Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
12324search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
12325default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
12326larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
12327and therefore the longer it takes to run.
104c1213 12328
8e04817f
AC
12329@item show heuristic-fence-post
12330Display the current limit.
12331@end table
104c1213
JM
12332
12333@noindent
8e04817f
AC
12334These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
12335for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
104c1213 12336
104c1213 12337
8e04817f
AC
12338@node Controlling GDB
12339@chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
12340
12341You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
12342@code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
12343data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}. Other settings are
12344described here.
12345
12346@menu
12347* Prompt:: Prompt
12348* Editing:: Command editing
12349* History:: Command history
12350* Screen Size:: Screen size
12351* Numbers:: Numbers
1e698235 12352* ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
8e04817f
AC
12353* Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
12354* Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
12355@end menu
12356
12357@node Prompt
12358@section Prompt
104c1213 12359
8e04817f 12360@cindex prompt
104c1213 12361
8e04817f
AC
12362@value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
12363called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
12364can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
12365instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
12366the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
12367which one you are talking to.
104c1213 12368
8e04817f
AC
12369@emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
12370prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
12371or a prompt that does not.
104c1213 12372
8e04817f
AC
12373@table @code
12374@kindex set prompt
12375@item set prompt @var{newprompt}
12376Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
104c1213 12377
8e04817f
AC
12378@kindex show prompt
12379@item show prompt
12380Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
104c1213
JM
12381@end table
12382
8e04817f
AC
12383@node Editing
12384@section Command editing
12385@cindex readline
12386@cindex command line editing
104c1213 12387
8e04817f
AC
12388@value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{readline} interface. This
12389@sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
12390command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
12391or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
12392substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
12393debugging sessions.
104c1213 12394
8e04817f
AC
12395You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
12396command @code{set}.
104c1213 12397
8e04817f
AC
12398@table @code
12399@kindex set editing
12400@cindex editing
12401@item set editing
12402@itemx set editing on
12403Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
104c1213 12404
8e04817f
AC
12405@item set editing off
12406Disable command line editing.
104c1213 12407
8e04817f
AC
12408@kindex show editing
12409@item show editing
12410Show whether command line editing is enabled.
104c1213
JM
12411@end table
12412
8e04817f
AC
12413@node History
12414@section Command history
12415
12416@value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
12417debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
12418happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
12419history facility.
104c1213
JM
12420
12421@table @code
8e04817f
AC
12422@cindex history substitution
12423@cindex history file
12424@kindex set history filename
12425@kindex GDBHISTFILE
12426@item set history filename @var{fname}
12427Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
12428This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
12429list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
12430exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
12431the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
12432to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
12433@file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
12434is not set.
104c1213 12435
8e04817f
AC
12436@cindex history save
12437@kindex set history save
12438@item set history save
12439@itemx set history save on
12440Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
12441@code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
104c1213 12442
8e04817f
AC
12443@item set history save off
12444Stop recording command history in a file.
104c1213 12445
8e04817f
AC
12446@cindex history size
12447@kindex set history size
12448@item set history size @var{size}
12449Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
12450This defaults to the value of the environment variable
12451@code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
104c1213
JM
12452@end table
12453
8e04817f
AC
12454@cindex history expansion
12455History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
12456@ifset have-readline-appendices
12457@xref{Event Designators}.
12458@end ifset
12459
12460Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
12461is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
12462@code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
12463follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
12464a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
12465history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
12466@kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
12467
12468The commands to control history expansion are:
104c1213
JM
12469
12470@table @code
8e04817f
AC
12471@kindex set history expansion
12472@item set history expansion on
12473@itemx set history expansion
12474Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
104c1213 12475
8e04817f
AC
12476@item set history expansion off
12477Disable history expansion.
104c1213 12478
8e04817f
AC
12479The readline code comes with more complete documentation of
12480editing and history expansion features. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs
12481or @code{vi} may wish to read it.
12482@ifset have-readline-appendices
12483@xref{Command Line Editing}.
12484@end ifset
104c1213 12485
8e04817f
AC
12486@c @group
12487@kindex show history
12488@item show history
12489@itemx show history filename
12490@itemx show history save
12491@itemx show history size
12492@itemx show history expansion
12493These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
12494@code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
12495@c @end group
12496@end table
12497
12498@table @code
12499@kindex shows
12500@item show commands
12501Display the last ten commands in the command history.
104c1213 12502
8e04817f
AC
12503@item show commands @var{n}
12504Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
12505
12506@item show commands +
12507Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
104c1213
JM
12508@end table
12509
8e04817f
AC
12510@node Screen Size
12511@section Screen size
12512@cindex size of screen
12513@cindex pauses in output
104c1213 12514
8e04817f
AC
12515Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
12516information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
12517@value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
12518output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
12519to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
12520determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
12521printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
12522rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
12523
12524Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
12525driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
12526together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
12527@code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
12528you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
12529width} commands:
12530
12531@table @code
12532@kindex set height
12533@kindex set width
12534@kindex show width
12535@kindex show height
12536@item set height @var{lpp}
12537@itemx show height
12538@itemx set width @var{cpl}
12539@itemx show width
12540These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
12541a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
12542commands display the current settings.
104c1213 12543
8e04817f
AC
12544If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
12545output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
12546file or to an editor buffer.
104c1213 12547
8e04817f
AC
12548Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
12549from wrapping its output.
104c1213
JM
12550@end table
12551
8e04817f
AC
12552@node Numbers
12553@section Numbers
12554@cindex number representation
12555@cindex entering numbers
104c1213 12556
8e04817f
AC
12557You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
12558@value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
12559@samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
12560begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that begin with none of these are, by
12561default, entered in base 10; likewise, the default display for
12562numbers---when no particular format is specified---is base 10. You can
12563change the default base for both input and output with the @code{set
12564radix} command.
104c1213 12565
8e04817f
AC
12566@table @code
12567@kindex set input-radix
12568@item set input-radix @var{base}
12569Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
12570for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
12571specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix; for
12572example, any of
104c1213 12573
8e04817f
AC
12574@smallexample
12575set radix 012
12576set radix 10.
12577set radix 0xa
12578@end smallexample
104c1213 12579
8e04817f
AC
12580@noindent
12581sets the base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set radix 10}
12582leaves the radix unchanged no matter what it was.
104c1213 12583
8e04817f
AC
12584@kindex set output-radix
12585@item set output-radix @var{base}
12586Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
12587for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
12588specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix.
104c1213 12589
8e04817f
AC
12590@kindex show input-radix
12591@item show input-radix
12592Display the current default base for numeric input.
104c1213 12593
8e04817f
AC
12594@kindex show output-radix
12595@item show output-radix
12596Display the current default base for numeric display.
12597@end table
104c1213 12598
1e698235
DJ
12599@node ABI
12600@section Configuring the current ABI
12601
12602@value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
12603application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
12604conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
12605current ABI.
12606
98b45e30
DJ
12607@cindex OS ABI
12608@kindex set osabi
b4e9345d 12609@kindex show osabi
98b45e30
DJ
12610
12611One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
12612system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
12613@value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
12614but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
12615One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
12616an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
12617not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
12618platform provides.
12619
12620@table @code
12621@item show osabi
12622Show the OS ABI currently in use.
12623
12624@item set osabi
12625With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
12626
12627@item set osabi @var{abi}
12628Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
12629@end table
12630
1e698235
DJ
12631@cindex float promotion
12632@kindex set coerce-float-to-double
12633
12634Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
12635function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
12636(i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
12637according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
12638(i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
12639@code{double} and then passed.
12640
12641Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
12642a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
12643as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
12644
12645@table @code
12646@item set coerce-float-to-double
12647@itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
12648Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
12649to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
12650
12651@item set coerce-float-to-double off
12652Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
12653functions.
12654@end table
12655
8e04817f
AC
12656@node Messages/Warnings
12657@section Optional warnings and messages
104c1213 12658
8e04817f
AC
12659By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
12660running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
12661command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
12662internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
104c1213 12663
8e04817f
AC
12664Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
12665which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
12666see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
104c1213 12667
8e04817f
AC
12668@table @code
12669@kindex set verbose
12670@item set verbose on
12671Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
104c1213 12672
8e04817f
AC
12673@item set verbose off
12674Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
104c1213 12675
8e04817f
AC
12676@kindex show verbose
12677@item show verbose
12678Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
12679@end table
104c1213 12680
8e04817f
AC
12681By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
12682object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
12683find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors reading
12684symbol files}).
104c1213 12685
8e04817f 12686@table @code
104c1213 12687
8e04817f
AC
12688@kindex set complaints
12689@item set complaints @var{limit}
12690Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
12691unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
12692@var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
12693to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
104c1213 12694
8e04817f
AC
12695@kindex show complaints
12696@item show complaints
12697Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
104c1213 12698
8e04817f 12699@end table
104c1213 12700
8e04817f
AC
12701By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
12702lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
12703you try to run a program which is already running:
104c1213 12704
474c8240 12705@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12706(@value{GDBP}) run
12707The program being debugged has been started already.
12708Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
474c8240 12709@end smallexample
104c1213 12710
8e04817f
AC
12711If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
12712commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
104c1213 12713
8e04817f 12714@table @code
104c1213 12715
8e04817f
AC
12716@kindex set confirm
12717@cindex flinching
12718@cindex confirmation
12719@cindex stupid questions
12720@item set confirm off
12721Disables confirmation requests.
104c1213 12722
8e04817f
AC
12723@item set confirm on
12724Enables confirmation requests (the default).
104c1213 12725
8e04817f
AC
12726@kindex show confirm
12727@item show confirm
12728Displays state of confirmation requests.
12729
12730@end table
104c1213 12731
8e04817f
AC
12732@node Debugging Output
12733@section Optional messages about internal happenings
104c1213 12734@table @code
8e04817f
AC
12735@kindex set debug arch
12736@item set debug arch
12737Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
12738@kindex show debug arch
12739@item show debug arch
12740Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
12741@kindex set debug event
12742@item set debug event
12743Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
12744default is off.
12745@kindex show debug event
12746@item show debug event
12747Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
12748info.
12749@kindex set debug expression
12750@item set debug expression
12751Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} expression debugging info. The
12752default is off.
12753@kindex show debug expression
12754@item show debug expression
12755Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} expression
12756debugging info.
12757@kindex set debug overload
12758@item set debug overload
12759Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
12760info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
12761is off.
12762@kindex show debug overload
12763@item show debug overload
12764Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
12765debugging info.
12766@kindex set debug remote
12767@cindex packets, reporting on stdout
12768@cindex serial connections, debugging
12769@item set debug remote
12770Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
12771the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
12772@value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
12773@kindex show debug remote
12774@item show debug remote
12775Displays the state of display of remote packets.
12776@kindex set debug serial
12777@item set debug serial
12778Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
12779default is off.
12780@kindex show debug serial
12781@item show debug serial
12782Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
12783info.
12784@kindex set debug target
12785@item set debug target
12786Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
12787includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
12788default is off.
12789@kindex show debug target
12790@item show debug target
12791Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
12792info.
12793@kindex set debug varobj
12794@item set debug varobj
12795Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
12796info. The default is off.
12797@kindex show debug varobj
12798@item show debug varobj
12799Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
12800debugging info.
12801@end table
104c1213 12802
8e04817f
AC
12803@node Sequences
12804@chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
104c1213 12805
8e04817f
AC
12806Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
12807command lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
12808commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
12809files.
104c1213 12810
8e04817f
AC
12811@menu
12812* Define:: User-defined commands
12813* Hooks:: User-defined command hooks
12814* Command Files:: Command files
12815* Output:: Commands for controlled output
12816@end menu
104c1213 12817
8e04817f
AC
12818@node Define
12819@section User-defined commands
104c1213 12820
8e04817f
AC
12821@cindex user-defined command
12822A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
12823which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
12824@code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
12825separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
12826via @var{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
104c1213 12827
8e04817f
AC
12828@smallexample
12829define adder
12830 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
12831@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
12832
12833@noindent
8e04817f 12834To execute the command use:
104c1213 12835
8e04817f
AC
12836@smallexample
12837adder 1 2 3
12838@end smallexample
104c1213 12839
8e04817f
AC
12840@noindent
12841This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
12842its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
12843reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
12844functions calls.
104c1213
JM
12845
12846@table @code
104c1213 12847
8e04817f
AC
12848@kindex define
12849@item define @var{commandname}
12850Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
12851by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
104c1213 12852
8e04817f
AC
12853The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
12854which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
12855commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
104c1213 12856
8e04817f
AC
12857@kindex if
12858@kindex else
12859@item if
12860Takes a single argument, which is an expression to evaluate.
12861It is followed by a series of commands that are executed
12862only if the expression is true (nonzero).
12863There can then optionally be a line @code{else}, followed
12864by a series of commands that are only executed if the expression
12865was false. The end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
104c1213 12866
8e04817f
AC
12867@kindex while
12868@item while
12869The syntax is similar to @code{if}: the command takes a single argument,
12870which is an expression to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to
12871execute, one per line, terminated by an @code{end}.
12872The commands are executed repeatedly as long as the expression
12873evaluates to true.
104c1213 12874
8e04817f
AC
12875@kindex document
12876@item document @var{commandname}
12877Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
12878accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
12879defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
12880reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
12881After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
12882@var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
104c1213 12883
8e04817f
AC
12884You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
12885documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
12886does not change the documentation.
104c1213 12887
8e04817f
AC
12888@kindex help user-defined
12889@item help user-defined
12890List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
12891(if any) for each.
104c1213 12892
8e04817f
AC
12893@kindex show user
12894@item show user
12895@itemx show user @var{commandname}
12896Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
12897not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
12898definitions for all user-defined commands.
104c1213 12899
20f01a46
DH
12900@kindex show max-user-call-depth
12901@kindex set max-user-call-depth
12902@item show max-user-call-depth
5ca0cb28
DH
12903@itemx set max-user-call-depth
12904The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
12905levels are allowed in user-defined commands before GDB suspects an
12906infinite recursion and aborts the command.
20f01a46 12907
104c1213
JM
12908@end table
12909
8e04817f
AC
12910When user-defined commands are executed, the
12911commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
12912stops execution of the user-defined command.
104c1213 12913
8e04817f
AC
12914If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
12915without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
12916commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
12917messages when used in a user-defined command.
104c1213 12918
8e04817f
AC
12919@node Hooks
12920@section User-defined command hooks
12921@cindex command hooks
12922@cindex hooks, for commands
12923@cindex hooks, pre-command
104c1213 12924
8e04817f
AC
12925@kindex hook
12926@kindex hook-
12927You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
12928command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
12929command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
12930before that command.
104c1213 12931
8e04817f
AC
12932@cindex hooks, post-command
12933@kindex hookpost
12934@kindex hookpost-
12935A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
12936Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
12937@samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
12938that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
12939pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
104c1213 12940
8e04817f
AC
12941It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
12942occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinte recursion.
104c1213 12943
8e04817f
AC
12944@c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
12945@c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
104c1213 12946
8e04817f
AC
12947@kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
12948In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
12949(@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
12950execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
12951displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
104c1213 12952
8e04817f
AC
12953For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
12954single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
12955you could define:
104c1213 12956
474c8240 12957@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12958define hook-stop
12959handle SIGALRM nopass
12960end
104c1213 12961
8e04817f
AC
12962define hook-run
12963handle SIGALRM pass
12964end
104c1213 12965
8e04817f
AC
12966define hook-continue
12967handle SIGLARM pass
12968end
474c8240 12969@end smallexample
104c1213 12970
8e04817f
AC
12971As a further example, to hook at the begining and end of the @code{echo}
12972command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
12973you could define:
104c1213 12974
474c8240 12975@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12976define hook-echo
12977echo <<<---
12978end
104c1213 12979
8e04817f
AC
12980define hookpost-echo
12981echo --->>>\n
12982end
104c1213 12983
8e04817f
AC
12984(@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
12985<<<---Hello World--->>>
12986(@value{GDBP})
104c1213 12987
474c8240 12988@end smallexample
104c1213 12989
8e04817f
AC
12990You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
12991not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
12992name, e.g. @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
12993@c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
12994@c or not?
12995If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
12996@value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
12997(before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
104c1213 12998
8e04817f
AC
12999If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
13000get a warning from the @code{define} command.
c906108c 13001
8e04817f
AC
13002@node Command Files
13003@section Command files
c906108c 13004
8e04817f
AC
13005@cindex command files
13006A command file for @value{GDBN} is a file of lines that are @value{GDBN}
13007commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may also be included.
13008An empty line in a command file does nothing; it does not mean to repeat
13009the last command, as it would from the terminal.
c906108c 13010
8e04817f
AC
13011@cindex init file
13012@cindex @file{.gdbinit}
13013@cindex @file{gdb.ini}
13014When you start @value{GDBN}, it automatically executes commands from its
13015@dfn{init files}, normally called @file{.gdbinit}@footnote{The DJGPP
13016port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini} instead, due to the
13017limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems.}.
13018During startup, @value{GDBN} does the following:
c906108c 13019
8e04817f
AC
13020@enumerate
13021@item
13022Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
13023DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
13024@code{HOME} environment variable.}.
c906108c 13025
8e04817f
AC
13026@item
13027Processes command line options and operands.
c906108c 13028
8e04817f
AC
13029@item
13030Reads the init file (if any) in the current working directory.
c906108c 13031
8e04817f
AC
13032@item
13033Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option.
13034@end enumerate
c906108c 13035
8e04817f
AC
13036The init file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
13037complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
13038and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
13039option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing modes}).
c906108c 13040
8e04817f
AC
13041@cindex init file name
13042On some configurations of @value{GDBN}, the init file is known by a
13043different name (these are typically environments where a specialized
13044form of @value{GDBN} may need to coexist with other forms, hence a
13045different name for the specialized version's init file). These are the
13046environments with special init file names:
c906108c 13047
8e04817f
AC
13048@cindex @file{.vxgdbinit}
13049@itemize @bullet
13050@item
13051VxWorks (Wind River Systems real-time OS): @file{.vxgdbinit}
c906108c 13052
8e04817f
AC
13053@cindex @file{.os68gdbinit}
13054@item
13055OS68K (Enea Data Systems real-time OS): @file{.os68gdbinit}
c906108c 13056
8e04817f
AC
13057@cindex @file{.esgdbinit}
13058@item
13059ES-1800 (Ericsson Telecom AB M68000 emulator): @file{.esgdbinit}
13060@end itemize
c906108c 13061
8e04817f
AC
13062You can also request the execution of a command file with the
13063@code{source} command:
c906108c 13064
8e04817f
AC
13065@table @code
13066@kindex source
13067@item source @var{filename}
13068Execute the command file @var{filename}.
c906108c
SS
13069@end table
13070
8e04817f 13071The lines in a command file are executed sequentially. They are not
a71ec265
DH
13072printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
13073execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
c906108c 13074
8e04817f
AC
13075Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
13076without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
13077normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
13078when called from command files.
c906108c 13079
8e04817f
AC
13080@value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
13081mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
13082standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
13083not terminate execution of the command file --- execution continues with
13084the next command.
c906108c 13085
474c8240 13086@smallexample
8e04817f 13087gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
474c8240 13088@end smallexample
c906108c 13089
8e04817f
AC
13090(The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
13091will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
13092would be directed to @file{log}.
c906108c 13093
8e04817f
AC
13094@node Output
13095@section Commands for controlled output
c906108c 13096
8e04817f
AC
13097During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
13098@value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
13099explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
13100describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
13101want.
c906108c
SS
13102
13103@table @code
8e04817f
AC
13104@kindex echo
13105@item echo @var{text}
13106@c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
13107@c because it is not in ANSI.
13108Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
13109@var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
13110newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
13111In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
13112by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
13113string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
13114trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
13115To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
13116@samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
c906108c 13117
8e04817f
AC
13118A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
13119the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
c906108c 13120
474c8240 13121@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13122echo This is some text\n\
13123which is continued\n\
13124onto several lines.\n
474c8240 13125@end smallexample
c906108c 13126
8e04817f 13127produces the same output as
c906108c 13128
474c8240 13129@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13130echo This is some text\n
13131echo which is continued\n
13132echo onto several lines.\n
474c8240 13133@end smallexample
c906108c 13134
8e04817f
AC
13135@kindex output
13136@item output @var{expression}
13137Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
13138newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
13139value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
13140on expressions.
c906108c 13141
8e04817f
AC
13142@item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
13143Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
13144the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
13145formats}, for more information.
c906108c 13146
8e04817f
AC
13147@kindex printf
13148@item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
13149Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
13150@var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
13151either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
13152@var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
13153subroutine
13154@c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
13155@c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
13156@c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
13157@c supported.
c906108c 13158
474c8240 13159@smallexample
8e04817f 13160printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
474c8240 13161@end smallexample
c906108c 13162
8e04817f 13163For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
c906108c 13164
8e04817f
AC
13165@smallexample
13166printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
13167@end smallexample
c906108c 13168
8e04817f
AC
13169The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
13170string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
13171letter.
c906108c
SS
13172@end table
13173
8e04817f
AC
13174@node TUI
13175@chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
13176@cindex TUI
c906108c 13177
8e04817f
AC
13178@menu
13179* TUI Overview:: TUI overview
13180* TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
7cf36c78 13181* TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
8e04817f
AC
13182* TUI Commands:: TUI specific commands
13183* TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
13184@end menu
c906108c 13185
8e04817f
AC
13186The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface, TUI in short,
13187is a terminal interface which uses the @code{curses} library
13188to show the source file, the assembly output, the program registers
13189and @value{GDBN} commands in separate text windows.
13190The TUI is available only when @value{GDBN} is configured
13191with the @code{--enable-tui} configure option (@pxref{Configure Options}).
c906108c 13192
8e04817f
AC
13193@node TUI Overview
13194@section TUI overview
c906108c 13195
8e04817f
AC
13196The TUI has two display modes that can be switched while
13197@value{GDBN} runs:
c906108c 13198
8e04817f
AC
13199@itemize @bullet
13200@item
13201A curses (or TUI) mode in which it displays several text
13202windows on the terminal.
c906108c 13203
8e04817f
AC
13204@item
13205A standard mode which corresponds to the @value{GDBN} configured without
13206the TUI.
13207@end itemize
c906108c 13208
8e04817f
AC
13209In the TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text window
13210on the terminal:
c906108c 13211
8e04817f
AC
13212@table @emph
13213@item command
13214This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
13215prompt and the @value{GDBN} outputs. The @value{GDBN} input is still
13216managed using readline but through the TUI. The @emph{command}
13217window is always visible.
c906108c 13218
8e04817f
AC
13219@item source
13220The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
13221line as well as active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
c906108c 13222
8e04817f
AC
13223@item assembly
13224The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
c906108c 13225
8e04817f
AC
13226@item register
13227This window shows the processor registers. It detects when
13228a register is changed and when this is the case, registers that have
13229changed are highlighted.
c906108c 13230
c906108c
SS
13231@end table
13232
269c21fe
SC
13233The source and assembly windows show the current program position
13234by highlighting the current line and marking them with the @samp{>} marker.
13235Breakpoints are also indicated with two markers. A first one
13236indicates the breakpoint type:
13237
13238@table @code
13239@item B
13240Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
13241
13242@item b
13243Breakpoint which was never hit.
13244
13245@item H
13246Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
13247
13248@item h
13249Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
13250
13251@end table
13252
13253The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
13254
13255@table @code
13256@item +
13257Breakpoint is enabled.
13258
13259@item -
13260Breakpoint is disabled.
13261
13262@end table
13263
8e04817f
AC
13264The source, assembly and register windows are attached to the thread
13265and the frame position. They are updated when the current thread
13266changes, when the frame changes or when the program counter changes.
13267These three windows are arranged by the TUI according to several
13268layouts. The layout defines which of these three windows are visible.
13269The following layouts are available:
c906108c 13270
8e04817f
AC
13271@itemize @bullet
13272@item
13273source
2df3850c 13274
8e04817f
AC
13275@item
13276assembly
13277
13278@item
13279source and assembly
13280
13281@item
13282source and registers
c906108c 13283
8e04817f
AC
13284@item
13285assembly and registers
2df3850c 13286
8e04817f 13287@end itemize
c906108c 13288
b7bb15bc
SC
13289On top of the command window a status line gives various information
13290concerning the current process begin debugged. The status line is
13291updated when the information it shows changes. The following fields
13292are displayed:
13293
13294@table @emph
13295@item target
13296Indicates the current gdb target
13297(@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
13298
13299@item process
13300Gives information about the current process or thread number.
13301When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
13302
13303@item function
13304Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
13305The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
13306When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter
13307the string @code{??} is displayed.
13308
13309@item line
13310Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
13311When the current line number is not known the string @code{??} is displayed.
13312
13313@item pc
13314Indicates the current program counter address.
13315
13316@end table
13317
8e04817f
AC
13318@node TUI Keys
13319@section TUI Key Bindings
13320@cindex TUI key bindings
c906108c 13321
8e04817f
AC
13322The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
13323(@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
13324They allow to leave or enter in the TUI mode or they operate
7cf36c78
SC
13325directly on the TUI layout and windows. The TUI also provides
13326a @emph{SingleKey} keymap which binds several keys directly to
13327@value{GDBN} commands. The following key bindings
8e04817f 13328are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
c906108c 13329
8e04817f
AC
13330@table @kbd
13331@kindex C-x C-a
13332@item C-x C-a
13333@kindex C-x a
13334@itemx C-x a
13335@kindex C-x A
13336@itemx C-x A
13337Enter or leave the TUI mode. When the TUI mode is left,
13338the curses window management is left and @value{GDBN} operates using
13339its standard mode writing on the terminal directly. When the TUI
13340mode is entered, the control is given back to the curses windows.
13341The screen is then refreshed.
c906108c 13342
8e04817f
AC
13343@kindex C-x 1
13344@item C-x 1
13345Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
13346either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
13347is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
2df3850c 13348
8e04817f 13349Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
c906108c 13350
8e04817f
AC
13351@kindex C-x 2
13352@item C-x 2
13353Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
13354layout shows already two windows, a next layout with two windows is used.
13355When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
13356previous layout and the new one.
c906108c 13357
8e04817f 13358Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
2df3850c 13359
7cf36c78
SC
13360@kindex C-x s
13361@item C-x s
13362Use the TUI @emph{SingleKey} keymap that binds single key to gdb commands
13363(@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
13364
c906108c
SS
13365@end table
13366
8e04817f 13367The following key bindings are handled only by the TUI mode:
5d161b24 13368
8e04817f
AC
13369@table @key
13370@kindex PgUp
13371@item PgUp
13372Scroll the active window one page up.
c906108c 13373
8e04817f
AC
13374@kindex PgDn
13375@item PgDn
13376Scroll the active window one page down.
c906108c 13377
8e04817f
AC
13378@kindex Up
13379@item Up
13380Scroll the active window one line up.
c906108c 13381
8e04817f
AC
13382@kindex Down
13383@item Down
13384Scroll the active window one line down.
c906108c 13385
8e04817f
AC
13386@kindex Left
13387@item Left
13388Scroll the active window one column left.
c906108c 13389
8e04817f
AC
13390@kindex Right
13391@item Right
13392Scroll the active window one column right.
c906108c 13393
8e04817f
AC
13394@kindex C-L
13395@item C-L
13396Refresh the screen.
c906108c 13397
8e04817f 13398@end table
c906108c 13399
8e04817f
AC
13400In the TUI mode, the arrow keys are used by the active window
13401for scrolling. This means they are not available for readline. It is
13402necessary to use other readline key bindings such as @key{C-p}, @key{C-n},
13403@key{C-b} and @key{C-f}.
13404
7cf36c78
SC
13405@node TUI Single Key Mode
13406@section TUI Single Key Mode
13407@cindex TUI single key mode
13408
13409The TUI provides a @emph{SingleKey} mode in which it installs a particular
13410key binding in the readline keymaps to connect single keys to
13411some gdb commands.
13412
13413@table @kbd
13414@kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13415@item c
13416continue
13417
13418@kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13419@item d
13420down
13421
13422@kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13423@item f
13424finish
13425
13426@kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13427@item n
13428next
13429
13430@kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13431@item q
13432exit the @emph{SingleKey} mode.
13433
13434@kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13435@item r
13436run
13437
13438@kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13439@item s
13440step
13441
13442@kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13443@item u
13444up
13445
13446@kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13447@item v
13448info locals
13449
13450@kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13451@item w
13452where
13453
13454@end table
13455
13456Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
13457The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
13458it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
13459with the TUI @emph{SingleKey} mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
13460@emph{SingleKey} mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
13461this mode is by hitting @key{q} or @samp{@key{C-x} @key{s}}.
13462
13463
8e04817f
AC
13464@node TUI Commands
13465@section TUI specific commands
13466@cindex TUI commands
13467
13468The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
13469These commands are always available, that is they do not depend on
13470the current terminal mode in which @value{GDBN} runs. When @value{GDBN}
13471is in the standard mode, using these commands will automatically switch
13472in the TUI mode.
c906108c
SS
13473
13474@table @code
3d757584
SC
13475@item info win
13476@kindex info win
13477List and give the size of all displayed windows.
13478
8e04817f
AC
13479@item layout next
13480@kindex layout next
13481Display the next layout.
2df3850c 13482
8e04817f
AC
13483@item layout prev
13484@kindex layout prev
13485Display the previous layout.
c906108c 13486
8e04817f
AC
13487@item layout src
13488@kindex layout src
13489Display the source window only.
c906108c 13490
8e04817f
AC
13491@item layout asm
13492@kindex layout asm
13493Display the assembly window only.
c906108c 13494
8e04817f
AC
13495@item layout split
13496@kindex layout split
13497Display the source and assembly window.
c906108c 13498
8e04817f
AC
13499@item layout regs
13500@kindex layout regs
13501Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
13502
13503@item focus next | prev | src | asm | regs | split
13504@kindex focus
13505Set the focus to the named window.
13506This command allows to change the active window so that scrolling keys
13507can be affected to another window.
c906108c 13508
8e04817f
AC
13509@item refresh
13510@kindex refresh
13511Refresh the screen. This is similar to using @key{C-L} key.
c906108c 13512
8e04817f
AC
13513@item update
13514@kindex update
13515Update the source window and the current execution point.
c906108c 13516
8e04817f
AC
13517@item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
13518@itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
13519@kindex winheight
13520Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
13521lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
13522decrease it.
2df3850c 13523
c906108c
SS
13524@end table
13525
8e04817f
AC
13526@node TUI Configuration
13527@section TUI configuration variables
13528@cindex TUI configuration variables
c906108c 13529
8e04817f
AC
13530The TUI has several configuration variables that control the
13531appearance of windows on the terminal.
c906108c 13532
8e04817f
AC
13533@table @code
13534@item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
13535@kindex set tui border-kind
13536Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
13537The possible values are the following:
13538@table @code
13539@item space
13540Use a space character to draw the border.
c906108c 13541
8e04817f
AC
13542@item ascii
13543Use ascii characters + - and | to draw the border.
c906108c 13544
8e04817f
AC
13545@item acs
13546Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
13547drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
c78b4128 13548
8e04817f 13549@end table
c78b4128 13550
8e04817f
AC
13551@item set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
13552@kindex set tui active-border-mode
13553Select the attributes to display the border of the active window.
13554The possible values are @code{normal}, @code{standout}, @code{reverse},
13555@code{half}, @code{half-standout}, @code{bold} and @code{bold-standout}.
c78b4128 13556
8e04817f
AC
13557@item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
13558@kindex set tui border-mode
13559Select the attributes to display the border of other windows.
13560The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
13561@table @code
13562@item normal
13563Use normal attributes to display the border.
c906108c 13564
8e04817f
AC
13565@item standout
13566Use standout mode.
c906108c 13567
8e04817f
AC
13568@item reverse
13569Use reverse video mode.
c906108c 13570
8e04817f
AC
13571@item half
13572Use half bright mode.
c906108c 13573
8e04817f
AC
13574@item half-standout
13575Use half bright and standout mode.
c906108c 13576
8e04817f
AC
13577@item bold
13578Use extra bright or bold mode.
c78b4128 13579
8e04817f
AC
13580@item bold-standout
13581Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
c78b4128 13582
8e04817f 13583@end table
c78b4128 13584
8e04817f 13585@end table
c78b4128 13586
8e04817f
AC
13587@node Emacs
13588@chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
c78b4128 13589
8e04817f
AC
13590@cindex Emacs
13591@cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
13592A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
13593edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
13594@value{GDBN}.
c906108c 13595
8e04817f
AC
13596To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
13597executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
13598@value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
13599created Emacs buffer.
13600@c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
c906108c 13601
8e04817f
AC
13602Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
13603things:
c906108c 13604
8e04817f
AC
13605@itemize @bullet
13606@item
13607All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
13608@end itemize
c906108c 13609
8e04817f
AC
13610This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
13611and output done by the program you are debugging.
bf0184be 13612
8e04817f
AC
13613This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
13614commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
13615in this way.
bf0184be 13616
8e04817f
AC
13617All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
13618with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
13619way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
13620stop.
bf0184be 13621
8e04817f 13622@itemize @bullet
bf0184be 13623@item
8e04817f
AC
13624@value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
13625@end itemize
bf0184be 13626
8e04817f
AC
13627Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
13628source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
13629left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
13630source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
13631and the source.
bf0184be 13632
8e04817f
AC
13633Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
13634usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
c906108c 13635
8e04817f
AC
13636@quotation
13637@emph{Warning:} If the directory where your program resides is not your
13638current directory, it can be easy to confuse Emacs about the location of
13639the source files, in which case the auxiliary display buffer does not
13640appear to show your source. @value{GDBN} can find programs by searching your
13641environment's @code{PATH} variable, so the @value{GDBN} input and output
13642session proceeds normally; but Emacs does not get enough information
13643back from @value{GDBN} to locate the source files in this situation. To
13644avoid this problem, either start @value{GDBN} mode from the directory where
13645your program resides, or specify an absolute file name when prompted for the
13646@kbd{M-x gdb} argument.
c906108c 13647
8e04817f
AC
13648A similar confusion can result if you use the @value{GDBN} @code{file} command to
13649switch to debugging a program in some other location, from an existing
13650@value{GDBN} buffer in Emacs.
13651@end quotation
13652
13653By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If
13654you need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you keep
13655several configurations around, with different names) you can set the
13656Emacs variable @code{gdb-command-name}; for example,
13657
474c8240 13658@smallexample
8e04817f 13659(setq gdb-command-name "mygdb")
474c8240 13660@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13661
13662@noindent
13663(preceded by @kbd{M-:} or @kbd{ESC :}, or typed in the @code{*scratch*} buffer, or
13664in your @file{.emacs} file) makes Emacs call the program named
13665``@code{mygdb}'' instead.
13666
13667In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
13668addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
c906108c 13669
8e04817f
AC
13670@table @kbd
13671@item C-h m
13672Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
c906108c 13673
8e04817f
AC
13674@item M-s
13675Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
13676update the display window to show the current file and location.
c906108c 13677
8e04817f
AC
13678@item M-n
13679Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
13680calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
13681to show the current file and location.
c906108c 13682
8e04817f
AC
13683@item M-i
13684Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
13685display window accordingly.
c906108c 13686
8e04817f
AC
13687@item M-x gdb-nexti
13688Execute to next instruction, using the @value{GDBN} @code{nexti} command; update
13689display window accordingly.
c906108c 13690
8e04817f
AC
13691@item C-c C-f
13692Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
13693@code{finish} command.
c906108c 13694
8e04817f
AC
13695@item M-c
13696Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
13697command.
b433d00b 13698
8e04817f 13699@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-p}.
b433d00b 13700
8e04817f
AC
13701@item M-u
13702Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
13703(@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
13704like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
b433d00b 13705
8e04817f 13706@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-u}.
c906108c 13707
8e04817f
AC
13708@item M-d
13709Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
13710@value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
c906108c 13711
8e04817f 13712@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-d}.
c906108c 13713
8e04817f
AC
13714@item C-x &
13715Read the number where the cursor is positioned, and insert it at the end
13716of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer. For example, if you wish to disassemble code
13717around an address that was displayed earlier, type @kbd{disassemble};
13718then move the cursor to the address display, and pick up the
13719argument for @code{disassemble} by typing @kbd{C-x &}.
c906108c 13720
8e04817f
AC
13721You can customize this further by defining elements of the list
13722@code{gdb-print-command}; once it is defined, you can format or
13723otherwise process numbers picked up by @kbd{C-x &} before they are
13724inserted. A numeric argument to @kbd{C-x &} indicates that you
13725wish special formatting, and also acts as an index to pick an element of the
13726list. If the list element is a string, the number to be inserted is
13727formatted using the Emacs function @code{format}; otherwise the number
13728is passed as an argument to the corresponding list element.
13729@end table
c906108c 13730
8e04817f
AC
13731In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x SPC} (@code{gdb-break})
13732tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
c906108c 13733
8e04817f
AC
13734If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
13735it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
13736request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
13737the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
13738frame.
c906108c 13739
8e04817f
AC
13740The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
13741which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
13742the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
13743communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
13744delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
13745to correspond properly with the code.
c906108c 13746
8e04817f
AC
13747@c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
13748@c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
13749@ignore
13750@kindex Emacs Epoch environment
13751@kindex Epoch
13752@kindex inspect
c906108c 13753
8e04817f
AC
13754Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
13755called the @code{epoch}
13756environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
13757@code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
13758each value is printed in its own window.
13759@end ignore
c906108c 13760
8e04817f
AC
13761@include annotate.texi
13762@include gdbmi.texinfo
c906108c 13763
8e04817f
AC
13764@node GDB Bugs
13765@chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
13766@cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
13767@cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
c906108c 13768
8e04817f 13769Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
c906108c 13770
8e04817f
AC
13771Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
13772may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
13773the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
13774reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
c906108c 13775
8e04817f
AC
13776In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
13777information that enables us to fix the bug.
c4555f82
SC
13778
13779@menu
8e04817f
AC
13780* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
13781* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
c4555f82
SC
13782@end menu
13783
8e04817f
AC
13784@node Bug Criteria
13785@section Have you found a bug?
13786@cindex bug criteria
c4555f82 13787
8e04817f 13788If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
c4555f82
SC
13789
13790@itemize @bullet
8e04817f
AC
13791@cindex fatal signal
13792@cindex debugger crash
13793@cindex crash of debugger
c4555f82 13794@item
8e04817f
AC
13795If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
13796@value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
13797
13798@cindex error on valid input
13799@item
13800If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
13801bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
13802somewhere in the connection to the target.)
c4555f82 13803
8e04817f 13804@cindex invalid input
c4555f82 13805@item
8e04817f
AC
13806If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
13807that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
13808``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
13809for traditional practice''.
13810
13811@item
13812If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
13813for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
c4555f82
SC
13814@end itemize
13815
8e04817f
AC
13816@node Bug Reporting
13817@section How to report bugs
13818@cindex bug reports
13819@cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
13820
13821A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
13822If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
13823contact that organization first.
13824
13825You can find contact information for many support companies and
13826individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
13827distribution.
13828@c should add a web page ref...
13829
129188f6
AC
13830In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
13831@value{GDBN}. The prefered method is to submit them directly using
13832@uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
13833page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
13834be used.
8e04817f
AC
13835
13836@strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
13837@samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
13838not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
13839@samp{bug-gdb}.
13840
13841The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
13842serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
13843the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
13844newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
13845problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
13846path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
13847we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
13848bug reports to the mailing list.
c4555f82 13849
8e04817f
AC
13850The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
13851@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
13852fact or leave it out, state it!
c4555f82 13853
8e04817f
AC
13854Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
13855problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
13856assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
13857Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
13858stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
13859name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
13860of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
13861the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
13862easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
c4555f82 13863
8e04817f
AC
13864Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
13865bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
13866you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
13867self-contained.
c4555f82 13868
8e04817f
AC
13869Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
13870bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
13871@emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
13872bugs properly.
13873
13874To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
c4555f82
SC
13875
13876@itemize @bullet
13877@item
8e04817f
AC
13878The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
13879with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
13880version}.
c4555f82 13881
8e04817f
AC
13882Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
13883the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
c4555f82
SC
13884
13885@item
8e04817f
AC
13886The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
13887version number.
c4555f82
SC
13888
13889@item
8e04817f
AC
13890What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.
13891``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
c4555f82
SC
13892
13893@item
8e04817f
AC
13894What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
13895debugging---e.g. ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
13896C Compiler''. For GCC, you can say @code{gcc --version} to get this
13897information; for other compilers, see the documentation for those
13898compilers.
c4555f82 13899
8e04817f
AC
13900@item
13901The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
13902observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
13903you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
13904Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
c4555f82 13905
8e04817f
AC
13906If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
13907and then we might not encounter the bug.
c4555f82 13908
8e04817f
AC
13909@item
13910A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
13911reproduce the bug.
c4555f82 13912
8e04817f
AC
13913@item
13914A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
13915incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
c4555f82 13916
8e04817f
AC
13917Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
13918will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
13919not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
13920a chance to make a mistake.
c4555f82 13921
8e04817f
AC
13922Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
13923say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
13924copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
13925the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
13926crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
13927ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
13928us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
13929to draw any conclusion from our observations.
c4555f82 13930
8e04817f
AC
13931@item
13932If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
13933diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
13934it by context, not by line number.
c4555f82 13935
8e04817f
AC
13936The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
13937sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
c4555f82 13938
8e04817f 13939@end itemize
c4555f82 13940
8e04817f 13941Here are some things that are not necessary:
c4555f82 13942
8e04817f
AC
13943@itemize @bullet
13944@item
13945A description of the envelope of the bug.
c4555f82 13946
8e04817f
AC
13947Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
13948which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
13949changes will not affect it.
c4555f82 13950
8e04817f
AC
13951This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
13952will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
13953with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
13954We recommend that you save your time for something else.
c4555f82 13955
8e04817f
AC
13956Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
13957of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
13958output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
13959less time, and so on.
c4555f82 13960
8e04817f
AC
13961However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
13962report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
c4555f82 13963
8e04817f
AC
13964@item
13965A patch for the bug.
c4555f82 13966
8e04817f
AC
13967A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
13968the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
13969a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
13970to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
c4555f82 13971
8e04817f
AC
13972Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
13973construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
13974through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
13975to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
c4555f82 13976
8e04817f
AC
13977And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
13978patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
13979help us to understand.
c4555f82 13980
8e04817f
AC
13981@item
13982A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
c4555f82 13983
8e04817f
AC
13984Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
13985things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
13986@end itemize
c4555f82 13987
8e04817f
AC
13988@c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
13989@c and consists of the two following files:
13990@c rluser.texinfo
13991@c inc-hist.texinfo
13992@c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
13993@c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
13994@include rluser.texinfo
13995@include inc-hist.texinfo
c4555f82 13996
c4555f82 13997
8e04817f
AC
13998@node Formatting Documentation
13999@appendix Formatting Documentation
c4555f82 14000
8e04817f
AC
14001@cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
14002@cindex reference card
14003The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
14004for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
14005subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
14006@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
14007release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
14008you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
c4555f82 14009
8e04817f
AC
14010The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
14011can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
c4555f82 14012
474c8240 14013@smallexample
8e04817f 14014make refcard.dvi
474c8240 14015@end smallexample
c4555f82 14016
8e04817f
AC
14017The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
14018mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
14019that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
14020high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
14021your @sc{dvi} output program.
c4555f82 14022
8e04817f 14023@cindex documentation
c4555f82 14024
8e04817f
AC
14025All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
14026distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
14027a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
14028on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
14029formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
14030and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
c4555f82 14031
8e04817f
AC
14032@value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
14033version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
14034file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
14035subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
14036necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
14037but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
14038Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
14039@sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
c4555f82 14040
8e04817f
AC
14041If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
14042Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
14043@code{makeinfo}.
c4555f82 14044
8e04817f
AC
14045If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
14046@value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
14047version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
c4555f82 14048
474c8240 14049@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
14050cd gdb
14051make gdb.info
474c8240 14052@end smallexample
c4555f82 14053
8e04817f
AC
14054If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
14055a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
14056Texinfo definitions file.
c4555f82 14057
8e04817f
AC
14058@TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
14059produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
14060document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
14061has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
14062command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
14063(for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
14064require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
c4555f82 14065
8e04817f
AC
14066@TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
14067@file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
14068written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
14069typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
14070and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
14071directory.
c4555f82 14072
8e04817f
AC
14073If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
14074typeset and print this manual. First switch to the the @file{gdb}
14075subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
14076@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
c4555f82 14077
474c8240 14078@smallexample
8e04817f 14079make gdb.dvi
474c8240 14080@end smallexample
c4555f82 14081
8e04817f 14082Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
c4555f82 14083
8e04817f
AC
14084@node Installing GDB
14085@appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
14086@cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
14087@cindex installation
c4555f82 14088
8e04817f
AC
14089@value{GDBN} comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process
14090of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
14091build the @code{gdb} program.
14092@iftex
14093@c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
14094@footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
14095look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
14096installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
14097@end iftex
c4555f82 14098
8e04817f
AC
14099The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
14100@value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
14101appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
c4555f82 14102
8e04817f
AC
14103For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
14104@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
c4555f82 14105
8e04817f
AC
14106@table @code
14107@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
14108script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
c4555f82 14109
8e04817f
AC
14110@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
14111the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
c4555f82 14112
8e04817f
AC
14113@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
14114source for the Binary File Descriptor library
c906108c 14115
8e04817f
AC
14116@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
14117@sc{gnu} include files
c906108c 14118
8e04817f
AC
14119@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
14120source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
c906108c 14121
8e04817f
AC
14122@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
14123source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
c906108c 14124
8e04817f
AC
14125@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
14126source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
c906108c 14127
8e04817f
AC
14128@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
14129source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
c906108c 14130
8e04817f
AC
14131@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
14132source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
14133@end table
c906108c 14134
8e04817f
AC
14135The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @code{configure}
14136from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
14137this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
c906108c 14138
8e04817f
AC
14139First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
14140if you are not already in it; then run @code{configure}. Pass the
14141identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
14142argument.
c906108c 14143
8e04817f 14144For example:
c906108c 14145
474c8240 14146@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
14147cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
14148./configure @var{host}
14149make
474c8240 14150@end smallexample
c906108c 14151
8e04817f
AC
14152@noindent
14153where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
14154@samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
14155(You can often leave off @var{host}; @code{configure} tries to guess the
14156correct value by examining your system.)
c906108c 14157
8e04817f
AC
14158Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
14159@file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
14160libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
14161binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
c906108c 14162
8e04817f
AC
14163@need 750
14164@code{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
14165system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
14166shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
c906108c 14167
474c8240 14168@smallexample
8e04817f 14169sh configure @var{host}
474c8240 14170@end smallexample
c906108c 14171
8e04817f
AC
14172If you run @code{configure} from a directory that contains source
14173directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
14174@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, @code{configure}
14175creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
14176you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
14177
14178You can run the @code{configure} script from any of the
14179subordinate directories in the @value{GDBN} distribution if you only want to
14180configure that subdirectory, but be sure to specify a path to it.
c906108c 14181
8e04817f
AC
14182For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, type the following to configure only
14183the @code{bfd} subdirectory:
c906108c 14184
474c8240 14185@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
14186@group
14187cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
14188../configure @var{host}
14189@end group
474c8240 14190@end smallexample
c906108c 14191
8e04817f
AC
14192You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
14193However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
14194the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
14195that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
14196let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
c906108c 14197
8e04817f
AC
14198@menu
14199* Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
14200* Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
14201* Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
14202@end menu
c906108c 14203
8e04817f
AC
14204@node Separate Objdir
14205@section Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
c906108c 14206
8e04817f
AC
14207If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
14208you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
14209host and target. @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by
14210allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
14211rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
14212handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
14213@code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
14214program specified there.
c906108c 14215
8e04817f
AC
14216To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @code{configure}
14217with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
14218(You also need to specify a path to find @code{configure}
14219itself from your working directory. If the path to @code{configure}
14220would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
14221the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
c906108c 14222
8e04817f
AC
14223For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
14224separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
c906108c 14225
474c8240 14226@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
14227@group
14228cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
14229mkdir ../gdb-sun4
14230cd ../gdb-sun4
14231../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
14232make
14233@end group
474c8240 14234@end smallexample
c906108c 14235
8e04817f
AC
14236When @code{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
14237directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
14238(and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
14239the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
14240directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
14241@file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
c906108c 14242
8e04817f
AC
14243One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
14244directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
14245@value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
14246programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
14247You specify a cross-debugging target by
14248giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}.
c906108c 14249
8e04817f
AC
14250When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
14251it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
14252called @code{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
c906108c 14253
8e04817f
AC
14254The @code{Makefile} that @code{configure} generates in each source
14255directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
14256directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
14257directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
14258will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
c906108c 14259
8e04817f
AC
14260When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
14261directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
14262if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
14263with each other.
c906108c 14264
8e04817f
AC
14265@node Config Names
14266@section Specifying names for hosts and targets
c906108c 14267
8e04817f
AC
14268The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure}
14269script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
14270aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
14271of information in the following pattern:
c906108c 14272
474c8240 14273@smallexample
8e04817f 14274@var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
474c8240 14275@end smallexample
c906108c 14276
8e04817f
AC
14277For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
14278or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
14279option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
c906108c 14280
8e04817f
AC
14281The @code{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
14282any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
14283aliases. @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
14284@code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
14285script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
14286abbreviations---for example:
c906108c 14287
8e04817f
AC
14288@smallexample
14289% sh config.sub i386-linux
14290i386-pc-linux-gnu
14291% sh config.sub alpha-linux
14292alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
14293% sh config.sub hp9k700
14294hppa1.1-hp-hpux
14295% sh config.sub sun4
14296sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
14297% sh config.sub sun3
14298m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
14299% sh config.sub i986v
14300Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
14301@end smallexample
c906108c 14302
8e04817f
AC
14303@noindent
14304@code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
14305directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
d700128c 14306
8e04817f
AC
14307@node Configure Options
14308@section @code{configure} options
c906108c 14309
8e04817f
AC
14310Here is a summary of the @code{configure} options and arguments that
14311are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @code{configure} also has
14312several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
14313Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @code{configure}.
c906108c 14314
474c8240 14315@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
14316configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
14317 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
14318 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
14319 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
14320 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
14321 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
14322 @var{host}
474c8240 14323@end smallexample
c906108c 14324
8e04817f
AC
14325@noindent
14326You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
14327@samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
14328@samp{--}.
c906108c 14329
8e04817f
AC
14330@table @code
14331@item --help
14332Display a quick summary of how to invoke @code{configure}.
c906108c 14333
8e04817f
AC
14334@item --prefix=@var{dir}
14335Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
14336@file{@var{dir}}.
c906108c 14337
8e04817f
AC
14338@item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
14339Configure the source to install programs under directory
14340@file{@var{dir}}.
c906108c 14341
8e04817f
AC
14342@c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
14343@need 2000
14344@item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
14345@strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
14346@code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
14347Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
14348@value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
14349build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
14350directories. @code{configure} writes configuration specific files in
14351the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
14352directory @var{dirname}. @code{configure} creates directories under
14353the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
14354@var{dirname}.
c906108c 14355
8e04817f
AC
14356@item --norecursion
14357Configure only the directory level where @code{configure} is executed; do not
14358propagate configuration to subdirectories.
c906108c 14359
8e04817f
AC
14360@item --target=@var{target}
14361Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
14362@var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
14363programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
c906108c 14364
8e04817f 14365There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
c906108c 14366
8e04817f
AC
14367@item @var{host} @dots{}
14368Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
c906108c 14369
8e04817f
AC
14370There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
14371@end table
c906108c 14372
8e04817f
AC
14373There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
14374needed for special purposes only.
c906108c 14375
8e04817f
AC
14376@node Maintenance Commands
14377@appendix Maintenance Commands
14378@cindex maintenance commands
14379@cindex internal commands
c906108c 14380
8e04817f
AC
14381In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
14382includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers.
14383These commands are provided here for reference.
c906108c 14384
8e04817f
AC
14385@table @code
14386@kindex maint info breakpoints
14387@item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
14388Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
14389breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
14390internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
14391breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
14392is shown:
c906108c 14393
8e04817f
AC
14394@table @code
14395@item breakpoint
14396Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
c906108c 14397
8e04817f
AC
14398@item watchpoint
14399Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
c906108c 14400
8e04817f
AC
14401@item longjmp
14402Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
14403@code{longjmp} calls.
c906108c 14404
8e04817f
AC
14405@item longjmp resume
14406Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
c906108c 14407
8e04817f
AC
14408@item until
14409Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
c906108c 14410
8e04817f
AC
14411@item finish
14412Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
c906108c 14413
8e04817f
AC
14414@item shlib events
14415Shared library events.
c906108c 14416
8e04817f 14417@end table
c906108c 14418
8d30a00d
AC
14419@kindex maint internal-error
14420@kindex maint internal-warning
14421@item maint internal-error
14422@itemx maint internal-warning
14423Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
14424or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
14425or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
14426internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
14427either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
14428@value{GDBN} session.
14429
14430@smallexample
14431(gdb) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
14432@dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
14433A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
14434debugging may prove unreliable.
14435Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
14436Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
14437(gdb)
14438@end smallexample
14439
14440Takes an optional parameter that is used as the text of the error or
14441warning message.
14442
0680b120
AC
14443@kindex maint print registers
14444@kindex maint print raw-registers
14445@kindex maint print cooked-registers
14446@item maint print registers
14447@itemx maint print raw-registers
14448@itemx maint print cooked-registers
14449Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
14450
14451The command @samp{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
14452the raw register cache; and the command @samp{maint print
14453cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers.
14454@xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint, @value{GDBN} Internals}.
14455
14456Takes an optional file parameter.
14457
8e04817f 14458@end table
c906108c 14459
c906108c 14460
e0ce93ac 14461@node Remote Protocol
8e04817f 14462@appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
c906108c 14463
ee2d5c50
AC
14464@menu
14465* Overview::
14466* Packets::
14467* Stop Reply Packets::
14468* General Query Packets::
14469* Register Packet Format::
14470* Examples::
14471@end menu
14472
14473@node Overview
14474@section Overview
14475
8e04817f
AC
14476There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
14477protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
14478machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
14479recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
c906108c 14480
d2c6833e 14481In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
8e04817f 14482transmitted and received data respectfully.
c906108c 14483
8e04817f
AC
14484@cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
14485@cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
14486@cindex remote serial protocol
14487All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
14488sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
14489@samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
14490@samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
c906108c 14491
474c8240 14492@smallexample
8e04817f 14493@code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
474c8240 14494@end smallexample
8e04817f 14495@noindent
c906108c 14496
8e04817f
AC
14497@cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
14498@noindent
14499The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
14500characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
14501eight bit unsigned checksum).
c906108c 14502
8e04817f
AC
14503Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
14504specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
c906108c 14505
474c8240 14506@smallexample
8e04817f 14507@code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
474c8240 14508@end smallexample
c906108c 14509
8e04817f
AC
14510@cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
14511@noindent
14512That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
14513has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
14514since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
c906108c 14515
8e04817f
AC
14516@cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
14517When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
14518response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
14519the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
14520retransmission):
c906108c 14521
474c8240 14522@smallexample
d2c6833e
AC
14523-> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
14524<- @code{+}
474c8240 14525@end smallexample
8e04817f 14526@noindent
53a5351d 14527
8e04817f
AC
14528The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
14529debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
14530the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
14531when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
c906108c 14532
8e04817f
AC
14533@var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
14534exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
14535exceptions).
c906108c 14536
8e04817f 14537Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
ee2d5c50 14538@cindex remote protocol, field separator
8e04817f 14539@samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
ee2d5c50 14540@sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
c906108c 14541
8e04817f
AC
14542Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
14543@samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
14544would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
c906108c 14545
8e04817f
AC
14546Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
14547means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
14548which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
14549@samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
14550where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
14551characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
14552value greater than 126 should not be used.
c906108c 14553
8e04817f
AC
14554Some remote systems have used a different run-length encoding mechanism
14555loosely refered to as the cisco encoding. Following the @samp{*}
14556character are two hex digits that indicate the size of the packet.
c906108c 14557
8e04817f 14558So:
474c8240 14559@smallexample
8e04817f 14560"@code{0* }"
474c8240 14561@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
14562@noindent
14563means the same as "0000".
c906108c 14564
8e04817f
AC
14565The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
14566error number. That number is not well defined.
c906108c 14567
8e04817f
AC
14568For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
14569(@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
14570protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
14571on that response.
c906108c 14572
8e04817f
AC
14573A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
14574@samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
14575optional.
c906108c 14576
ee2d5c50
AC
14577@node Packets
14578@section Packets
14579
14580The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
14581@var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
14582
14583@table @r
14584
14585@item @code{!} --- extended mode
14586@cindex @code{!} packet
14587
8e04817f
AC
14588Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
14589persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
14590debugged.
ee2d5c50
AC
14591
14592Reply:
14593@table @samp
14594@item OK
8e04817f 14595The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
ee2d5c50 14596@end table
c906108c 14597
ee2d5c50
AC
14598@item @code{?} --- last signal
14599@cindex @code{?} packet
c906108c 14600
ee2d5c50
AC
14601Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
14602step and continue.
c906108c 14603
ee2d5c50
AC
14604Reply:
14605@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
14606
14607@item @code{a} --- reserved
14608
14609Reserved for future use.
14610
14611@item @code{A}@var{arglen}@code{,}@var{argnum}@code{,}@var{arg}@code{,@dots{}} --- set program arguments @strong{(reserved)}
14612@cindex @code{A} packet
c906108c 14613
8e04817f
AC
14614Initialized @samp{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
14615specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream @var{arg}.
ee2d5c50
AC
14616See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
14617
14618Reply:
14619@table @samp
14620@item OK
14621@item E@var{NN}
14622@end table
14623
14624@item @code{b}@var{baud} --- set baud @strong{(deprecated)}
14625@cindex @code{b} packet
14626
14627Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
14628
14629JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
14630received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
14631problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
14632
14633Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
14634it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
14635some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
14636switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
14637of view, nothing actually happened.}
14638
14639@item @code{B}@var{addr},@var{mode} --- set breakpoint @strong{(deprecated)}
14640@cindex @code{B} packet
14641
8e04817f 14642Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
2f870471
AC
14643breakpoint at @var{addr}.
14644
14645This packet has been replaced by the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets
14646(@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
c906108c 14647
ee2d5c50
AC
14648@item @code{c}@var{addr} --- continue
14649@cindex @code{c} packet
14650
14651@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
8e04817f 14652current address.
c906108c 14653
ee2d5c50
AC
14654Reply:
14655@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
14656
14657@item @code{C}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr} --- continue with signal
14658@cindex @code{C} packet
14659
8e04817f
AC
14660Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
14661@code{;}@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
c906108c 14662
ee2d5c50
AC
14663Reply:
14664@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
c906108c 14665
ee2d5c50
AC
14666@item @code{d} --- toggle debug @strong{(deprecated)}
14667@cindex @code{d} packet
14668
14669Toggle debug flag.
14670
14671@item @code{D} --- detach
14672@cindex @code{D} packet
14673
14674Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target
14675before @value{GDBN} disconnects.
14676
14677Reply:
14678@table @samp
14679@item @emph{no response}
8e04817f 14680@value{GDBN} does not check for any response after sending this packet.
ee2d5c50 14681@end table
c906108c 14682
ee2d5c50 14683@item @code{e} --- reserved
c906108c 14684
ee2d5c50 14685Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14686
ee2d5c50 14687@item @code{E} --- reserved
c906108c 14688
ee2d5c50 14689Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14690
ee2d5c50
AC
14691@item @code{f} --- reserved
14692
14693Reserved for future use.
14694
14695@item @code{F} --- reserved
14696
14697Reserved for future use.
14698
14699@item @code{g} --- read registers
14700@anchor{read registers packet}
14701@cindex @code{g} packet
14702
14703Read general registers.
14704
14705Reply:
14706@table @samp
14707@item @var{XX@dots{}}
8e04817f
AC
14708Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
14709with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
14710each register and their position within the @samp{g} @var{packet} are
ee2d5c50
AC
14711determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros @var{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}
14712and @var{REGISTER_NAME} macros. The specification of several standard
8e04817f 14713@code{g} packets is specified below.
ee2d5c50
AC
14714@item E@var{NN}
14715for an error.
14716@end table
c906108c 14717
ee2d5c50
AC
14718@item @code{G}@var{XX@dots{}} --- write regs
14719@cindex @code{G} packet
c906108c 14720
ee2d5c50
AC
14721@xref{read registers packet}, for a description of the @var{XX@dots{}}
14722data.
14723
14724Reply:
14725@table @samp
14726@item OK
14727for success
14728@item E@var{NN}
14729for an error
14730@end table
14731
14732@item @code{h} --- reserved
14733
14734Reserved for future use.
14735
14736@item @code{H}@var{c}@var{t@dots{}} --- set thread
14737@cindex @code{H} packet
c906108c 14738
8e04817f 14739Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
ee2d5c50
AC
14740@samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
14741should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
14742operations. The thread designator @var{t@dots{}} may be -1, meaning all
14743the threads, a thread number, or zero which means pick any thread.
14744
14745Reply:
14746@table @samp
14747@item OK
14748for success
14749@item E@var{NN}
14750for an error
14751@end table
c906108c 14752
8e04817f
AC
14753@c FIXME: JTC:
14754@c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
14755@c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
14756@c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
14757@c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
14758@c described. For example:
14759@c
14760@c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
14761@c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
14762@c otherwise returns current registers.
14763@c
14764@c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
14765@c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
14766@c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
c906108c 14767
ee2d5c50
AC
14768@item @code{i}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{nnn} --- cycle step @strong{(draft)}
14769@anchor{cycle step packet}
14770@cindex @code{i} packet
14771
8e04817f
AC
14772Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @code{,}@var{nnn} is
14773present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
14774step starting at that address.
c906108c 14775
ee2d5c50
AC
14776@item @code{I} --- signal then cycle step @strong{(reserved)}
14777@cindex @code{I} packet
14778
14779@xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle step packet}.
14780
14781@item @code{j} --- reserved
14782
14783Reserved for future use.
14784
14785@item @code{J} --- reserved
c906108c 14786
ee2d5c50 14787Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14788
ee2d5c50
AC
14789@item @code{k} --- kill request
14790@cindex @code{k} packet
c906108c 14791
ac282366 14792FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
ee2d5c50
AC
14793thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
14794thread?)}.
c906108c 14795
ee2d5c50 14796@item @code{K} --- reserved
c906108c 14797
ee2d5c50
AC
14798Reserved for future use.
14799
14800@item @code{l} --- reserved
14801
14802Reserved for future use.
14803
14804@item @code{L} --- reserved
14805
14806Reserved for future use.
14807
14808@item @code{m}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- read memory
14809@cindex @code{m} packet
c906108c 14810
8e04817f 14811Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
ee2d5c50 14812Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that sized memory transfers are
2e834e49 14813assumed using word aligned accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory
8e04817f 14814transfer mechanism is needed.}
c906108c 14815
ee2d5c50
AC
14816Reply:
14817@table @samp
14818@item @var{XX@dots{}}
14819@var{XX@dots{}} is mem contents. Can be fewer bytes than requested if able
14820to read only part of the data. Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume
2e834e49 14821that sized memory transfers are assumed using word aligned
ee2d5c50
AC
14822accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory transfer mechanism is
14823needed.}
14824@item E@var{NN}
14825@var{NN} is errno
14826@end table
14827
14828@item @code{M}@var{addr},@var{length}@code{:}@var{XX@dots{}} --- write mem
14829@cindex @code{M} packet
14830
8e04817f 14831Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
ee2d5c50
AC
14832@var{XX@dots{}} is the data.
14833
14834Reply:
14835@table @samp
14836@item OK
14837for success
14838@item E@var{NN}
8e04817f
AC
14839for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
14840written).
ee2d5c50 14841@end table
c906108c 14842
ee2d5c50 14843@item @code{n} --- reserved
c906108c 14844
ee2d5c50 14845Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14846
ee2d5c50 14847@item @code{N} --- reserved
c906108c 14848
ee2d5c50 14849Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14850
ee2d5c50
AC
14851@item @code{o} --- reserved
14852
14853Reserved for future use.
14854
14855@item @code{O} --- reserved
14856
14857Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14858
ee2d5c50
AC
14859@item @code{p}@var{n@dots{}} --- read reg @strong{(reserved)}
14860@cindex @code{p} packet
14861
14862@xref{write register packet}.
14863
14864Reply:
14865@table @samp
14866@item @var{r@dots{}.}
14867The hex encoded value of the register in target byte order.
14868@end table
14869
14870@item @code{P}@var{n@dots{}}@code{=}@var{r@dots{}} --- write register
14871@anchor{write register packet}
14872@cindex @code{P} packet
14873
14874Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}, which contains two hex
8e04817f 14875digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
c906108c 14876
ee2d5c50
AC
14877Reply:
14878@table @samp
14879@item OK
14880for success
14881@item E@var{NN}
14882for an error
14883@end table
14884
14885@item @code{q}@var{query} --- general query
14886@anchor{general query packet}
14887@cindex @code{q} packet
14888
14889Request info about @var{query}. In general @value{GDBN} queries have a
14890leading upper case letter. Custom vendor queries should use a company
14891prefix (in lower case) ex: @samp{qfsf.var}. @var{query} may optionally
14892be followed by a @samp{,} or @samp{;} separated list. Stubs must ensure
14893that they match the full @var{query} name.
14894
14895Reply:
14896@table @samp
14897@item @var{XX@dots{}}
14898Hex encoded data from query. The reply can not be empty.
14899@item E@var{NN}
14900error reply
8e04817f 14901@item
ee2d5c50
AC
14902Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
14903@end table
14904
14905@item @code{Q}@var{var}@code{=}@var{val} --- general set
14906@cindex @code{Q} packet
14907
14908Set value of @var{var} to @var{val}.
14909
14910@xref{general query packet}, for a discussion of naming conventions.
c906108c 14911
ee2d5c50
AC
14912@item @code{r} --- reset @strong{(deprecated)}
14913@cindex @code{r} packet
c906108c 14914
8e04817f 14915Reset the entire system.
c906108c 14916
ee2d5c50
AC
14917@item @code{R}@var{XX} --- remote restart
14918@cindex @code{R} packet
14919
8e04817f
AC
14920Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
14921This packet is only available in extended mode.
ee2d5c50
AC
14922
14923Reply:
14924@table @samp
14925@item @emph{no reply}
8e04817f 14926The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
ee2d5c50
AC
14927@end table
14928
14929@item @code{s}@var{addr} --- step
14930@cindex @code{s} packet
c906108c 14931
8e04817f
AC
14932@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
14933same address.
c906108c 14934
ee2d5c50
AC
14935Reply:
14936@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
14937
14938@item @code{S}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr} --- step with signal
14939@anchor{step with signal packet}
14940@cindex @code{S} packet
14941
8e04817f 14942Like @samp{C} but step not continue.
c906108c 14943
ee2d5c50
AC
14944Reply:
14945@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
14946
14947@item @code{t}@var{addr}@code{:}@var{PP}@code{,}@var{MM} --- search
14948@cindex @code{t} packet
14949
8e04817f 14950Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
ee2d5c50
AC
14951@var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
14952@var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
c906108c 14953
ee2d5c50
AC
14954@item @code{T}@var{XX} --- thread alive
14955@cindex @code{T} packet
c906108c 14956
ee2d5c50 14957Find out if the thread XX is alive.
c906108c 14958
ee2d5c50
AC
14959Reply:
14960@table @samp
14961@item OK
14962thread is still alive
14963@item E@var{NN}
14964thread is dead
14965@end table
14966
14967@item @code{u} --- reserved
14968
14969Reserved for future use.
14970
14971@item @code{U} --- reserved
14972
14973Reserved for future use.
14974
14975@item @code{v} --- reserved
14976
14977Reserved for future use.
14978
14979@item @code{V} --- reserved
c906108c 14980
ee2d5c50 14981Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14982
ee2d5c50 14983@item @code{w} --- reserved
c906108c 14984
ee2d5c50 14985Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14986
ee2d5c50 14987@item @code{W} --- reserved
c906108c 14988
ee2d5c50 14989Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14990
ee2d5c50
AC
14991@item @code{x} --- reserved
14992
14993Reserved for future use.
14994
14995@item @code{X}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}@var{:}@var{XX@dots{}} --- write mem (binary)
14996@cindex @code{X} packet
14997
14998@var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes, @var{XX@dots{}}
14999is binary data. The characters @code{$}, @code{#}, and @code{0x7d} are
8e04817f 15000escaped using @code{0x7d}.
c906108c 15001
ee2d5c50
AC
15002Reply:
15003@table @samp
15004@item OK
15005for success
15006@item E@var{NN}
15007for an error
15008@end table
15009
15010@item @code{y} --- reserved
c906108c 15011
ee2d5c50 15012Reserved for future use.
c906108c 15013
ee2d5c50
AC
15014@item @code{Y} reserved
15015
15016Reserved for future use.
15017
2f870471
AC
15018@item @code{z}@var{type}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove breakpoint or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15019@itemx @code{Z}@var{type}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert breakpoint or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15020@anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
ee2d5c50 15021@cindex @code{z} packet
2f870471 15022@cindex @code{Z} packets
ee2d5c50 15023
2f870471
AC
15024Insert (@code{Z}) or remove (@code{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
15025watchpoint starting at address @var{address} and covering the next
15026@var{length} bytes.
ee2d5c50 15027
2f870471
AC
15028Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
15029separately.
15030
512217c7
AC
15031@emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
15032for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
15033remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
2f870471
AC
15034@code{Z}@var{type}@dots{} and @code{z}@var{type}@dots{} packet pair. To
15035avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
15036be implemented in an idempotent way.}
15037
15038@item @code{z}@code{0}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove memory breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
15039@item @code{Z}@code{0}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert memory breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
15040@cindex @code{z0} packet
15041@cindex @code{Z0} packet
15042
15043Insert (@code{Z0}) or remove (@code{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
15044@code{addr} of size @code{length}.
15045
15046A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
15047@var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
15048@code{length} is used by targets that indicates the size of the
15049breakpoint (in bytes) that should be inserted (e.g., the @sc{arm} and
15050@sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint).
c906108c 15051
2f870471
AC
15052@emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
15053code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
15054overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
15055target, is not defined.}
c906108c 15056
ee2d5c50
AC
15057Reply:
15058@table @samp
2f870471
AC
15059@item OK
15060success
15061@item
15062not supported
ee2d5c50
AC
15063@item E@var{NN}
15064for an error
2f870471
AC
15065@end table
15066
15067@item @code{z}@code{1}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove hardware breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
15068@item @code{Z}@code{1}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert hardware breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
15069@cindex @code{z1} packet
15070@cindex @code{Z1} packet
15071
15072Insert (@code{Z1}) or remove (@code{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
15073address @code{addr} of size @code{length}.
15074
15075A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
15076dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.
15077
15078@emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
15079movement.}
15080
15081Reply:
15082@table @samp
ee2d5c50 15083@item OK
2f870471
AC
15084success
15085@item
15086not supported
15087@item E@var{NN}
15088for an error
15089@end table
15090
15091@item @code{z}@code{2}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove write watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15092@item @code{Z}@code{2}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert write watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15093@cindex @code{z2} packet
15094@cindex @code{Z2} packet
15095
15096Insert (@code{Z2}) or remove (@code{z2}) a write watchpoint.
15097
15098Reply:
15099@table @samp
15100@item OK
15101success
15102@item
15103not supported
15104@item E@var{NN}
15105for an error
15106@end table
15107
15108@item @code{z}@code{3}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove read watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15109@item @code{Z}@code{3}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert read watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15110@cindex @code{z3} packet
15111@cindex @code{Z3} packet
15112
2e834e49 15113Insert (@code{Z3}) or remove (@code{z3}) a read watchpoint.
2f870471
AC
15114
15115Reply:
15116@table @samp
15117@item OK
15118success
15119@item
15120not supported
15121@item E@var{NN}
15122for an error
15123@end table
15124
2e834e49
HPN
15125@item @code{z}@code{4}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove access watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15126@item @code{Z}@code{4}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert access watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
2f870471
AC
15127@cindex @code{z4} packet
15128@cindex @code{Z4} packet
15129
15130Insert (@code{Z4}) or remove (@code{z4}) an access watchpoint.
15131
15132Reply:
15133@table @samp
15134@item OK
15135success
15136@item
15137not supported
15138@item E@var{NN}
15139for an error
ee2d5c50
AC
15140@end table
15141
15142@end table
c906108c 15143
ee2d5c50
AC
15144@node Stop Reply Packets
15145@section Stop Reply Packets
15146@cindex stop reply packets
c906108c 15147
8e04817f
AC
15148The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
15149receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
15150@samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
15151when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @samp{signal
15152number} is poorly defined. In general one of the UNIX signal numbering
15153conventions is used.
c906108c 15154
ee2d5c50 15155@table @samp
c906108c 15156
ee2d5c50
AC
15157@item S@var{AA}
15158@var{AA} is the signal number
c906108c 15159
8e04817f 15160@item @code{T}@var{AA}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}
ee2d5c50
AC
15161@cindex @code{T} packet reply
15162
8e04817f
AC
15163@var{AA} = two hex digit signal number; @var{n...} = register number
15164(hex), @var{r...} = target byte ordered register contents, size defined
15165by @code{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}; @var{n...} = @samp{thread}, @var{r...} =
3c3bea1c
GS
15166thread process ID, this is a hex integer; @var{n...} = (@samp{watch} |
15167@samp{rwatch} | @samp{awatch}, @var{r...} = data address, this is a hex
15168integer; @var{n...} = other string not starting with valid hex digit.
15169@value{GDBN} should ignore this @var{n...}, @var{r...} pair and go on
15170to the next. This way we can extend the protocol.
c906108c 15171
ee2d5c50
AC
15172@item W@var{AA}
15173
8e04817f 15174The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
ee2d5c50
AC
15175applicable to certain targets.
15176
15177@item X@var{AA}
c906108c 15178
8e04817f 15179The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
c906108c 15180
ee2d5c50
AC
15181@item N@var{AA};@var{t@dots{}};@var{d@dots{}};@var{b@dots{}} @strong{(obsolete)}
15182
15183@var{AA} = signal number; @var{t@dots{}} = address of symbol
15184@code{_start}; @var{d@dots{}} = base of data section; @var{b@dots{}} =
15185base of bss section. @emph{Note: only used by Cisco Systems targets.
15186The difference between this reply and the @samp{qOffsets} query is that
15187the @samp{N} packet may arrive spontaneously whereas the @samp{qOffsets}
15188is a query initiated by the host debugger.}
c906108c 15189
ee2d5c50 15190@item O@var{XX@dots{}}
c906108c 15191
ee2d5c50
AC
15192@var{XX@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data. This can happen at
15193any time while the program is running and the debugger should continue
15194to wait for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc.
15195
15196@end table
15197
15198@node General Query Packets
15199@section General Query Packets
c906108c 15200
8e04817f 15201The following set and query packets have already been defined.
c906108c 15202
ee2d5c50 15203@table @r
c906108c 15204
ee2d5c50
AC
15205@item @code{q}@code{C} --- current thread
15206
15207Return the current thread id.
15208
15209Reply:
15210@table @samp
15211@item @code{QC}@var{pid}
8e04817f 15212Where @var{pid} is a HEX encoded 16 bit process id.
ee2d5c50
AC
15213@item *
15214Any other reply implies the old pid.
15215@end table
15216
15217@item @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo} -- all thread ids
15218
15219@code{q}@code{sThreadInfo}
c906108c 15220
8e04817f
AC
15221Obtain a list of active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
15222may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
15223works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
15224obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
15225be the @code{qf}@code{ThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
15226sequence will be the @code{qs}@code{ThreadInfo} query.
ee2d5c50
AC
15227
15228NOTE: replaces the @code{qL} query (see below).
15229
15230Reply:
15231@table @samp
15232@item @code{m}@var{id}
15233A single thread id
15234@item @code{m}@var{id},@var{id}@dots{}
15235a comma-separated list of thread ids
15236@item @code{l}
15237(lower case 'el') denotes end of list.
15238@end table
15239
15240In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
15241more thread ids, in big-endian hex, separated by commas. @value{GDBN}
15242will respond to each reply with a request for more thread ids (using the
8e04817f
AC
15243@code{qs} form of the query), until the target responds with @code{l}
15244(lower-case el, for @code{'last'}).
c906108c 15245
ee2d5c50
AC
15246@item @code{q}@code{ThreadExtraInfo}@code{,}@var{id} --- extra thread info
15247
15248Where @var{id} is a thread-id in big-endian hex. Obtain a printable
15249string description of a thread's attributes from the target OS. This
15250string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting for
15251@value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is displayed
15252in @value{GDBN}'s @samp{info threads} display. Some examples of
15253possible thread extra info strings are ``Runnable'', or ``Blocked on
15254Mutex''.
15255
15256Reply:
15257@table @samp
15258@item @var{XX@dots{}}
15259Where @var{XX@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, comprising
15260the printable string containing the extra information about the thread's
8e04817f 15261attributes.
ee2d5c50
AC
15262@end table
15263
15264@item @code{q}@code{L}@var{startflag}@var{threadcount}@var{nextthread} --- query @var{LIST} or @var{threadLIST} @strong{(deprecated)}
c906108c 15265
8e04817f
AC
15266Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
15267digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
15268subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
15269number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
15270(eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
15271returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
ee2d5c50
AC
15272
15273NOTE: this query is replaced by the @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo} query
15274(see above).
15275
15276Reply:
15277@table @samp
15278@item @code{q}@code{M}@var{count}@var{done}@var{argthread}@var{thread@dots{}}
8e04817f
AC
15279Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
15280returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
15281and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
ee2d5c50
AC
15282digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread@dots{}}
15283is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
8e04817f 15284digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
ee2d5c50 15285@end table
c906108c 15286
ee2d5c50
AC
15287@item @code{q}@code{CRC:}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- compute CRC of memory block
15288
15289Reply:
15290@table @samp
15291@item @code{E}@var{NN}
15292An error (such as memory fault)
15293@item @code{C}@var{CRC32}
15294A 32 bit cyclic redundancy check of the specified memory region.
15295@end table
15296
15297@item @code{q}@code{Offsets} --- query sect offs
c906108c 15298
8e04817f
AC
15299Get section offsets that the target used when re-locating the downloaded
15300image. @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset is included in the
15301response, @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data}
15302offset to the @code{Bss} section.}
c906108c 15303
ee2d5c50
AC
15304Reply:
15305@table @samp
15306@item @code{Text=}@var{xxx}@code{;Data=}@var{yyy}@code{;Bss=}@var{zzz}
15307@end table
15308
15309@item @code{q}@code{P}@var{mode}@var{threadid} --- thread info request
15310
8e04817f
AC
15311Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
15312encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
ee2d5c50
AC
15313
15314Reply:
15315@table @samp
15316@item *
15317@end table
15318
8e04817f 15319See @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
c906108c 15320
ee2d5c50
AC
15321@item @code{q}@code{Rcmd,}@var{command} --- remote command
15322
15323@var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
8e04817f
AC
15324execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output string.
15325Before the final result packet, the target may also respond with a
ee2d5c50
AC
15326number of intermediate @code{O}@var{output} console output packets.
15327@emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a stubs's
15328interpreter may have security implications}.
15329
15330Reply:
15331@table @samp
15332@item OK
8e04817f 15333A command response with no output.
ee2d5c50 15334@item @var{OUTPUT}
8e04817f 15335A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
ee2d5c50 15336@item @code{E}@var{NN}
8e04817f 15337Indicate a badly formed request.
ee2d5c50 15338@item @samp{}
8e04817f 15339When @samp{q}@samp{Rcmd} is not recognized.
ee2d5c50
AC
15340@end table
15341
15342@item @code{qSymbol::} --- symbol lookup
c906108c 15343
8e04817f
AC
15344Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
15345requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
ee2d5c50
AC
15346
15347Reply:
15348@table @samp
15349@item @code{OK}
8e04817f 15350The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
ee2d5c50
AC
15351@item @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
15352The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
15353@value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
15354@code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name} message, described below.
15355@end table
15356
15357@item @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name} --- symbol value
15358
15359Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
15360
15361@var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
15362target has previously requested.
15363
15364@var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
15365@value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
15366will be empty.
15367
15368Reply:
15369@table @samp
15370@item @code{OK}
8e04817f 15371The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
ee2d5c50
AC
15372@item @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
15373The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
15374encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
15375(if available), until the target ceases to request them.
15376@end table
eb12ee30 15377
ee2d5c50
AC
15378@end table
15379
15380@node Register Packet Format
15381@section Register Packet Format
eb12ee30 15382
8e04817f 15383The following @samp{g}/@samp{G} packets have previously been defined.
ee2d5c50
AC
15384In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
15385sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
15386to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transfered in target
15387byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transfered
15388most-significant - least-significant.
eb12ee30 15389
ee2d5c50 15390@table @r
eb12ee30 15391
8e04817f 15392@item MIPS32
ee2d5c50 15393
8e04817f
AC
15394All registers are transfered as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
1539532 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
15396registers; fsr; fir; fp.
eb12ee30 15397
8e04817f 15398@item MIPS64
ee2d5c50 15399
8e04817f
AC
15400All registers are transfered as sixty-four bit quantities (including
15401thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
15402as @code{MIPS32}.
eb12ee30 15403
ee2d5c50
AC
15404@end table
15405
15406@node Examples
15407@section Examples
eb12ee30 15408
8e04817f
AC
15409Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
15410does not get any direct output:
eb12ee30 15411
474c8240 15412@smallexample
d2c6833e
AC
15413-> @code{R00}
15414<- @code{+}
8e04817f 15415@emph{target restarts}
d2c6833e 15416-> @code{?}
8e04817f 15417<- @code{+}
d2c6833e
AC
15418<- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
15419-> @code{+}
474c8240 15420@end smallexample
eb12ee30 15421
8e04817f 15422Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
eb12ee30 15423
474c8240 15424@smallexample
d2c6833e 15425-> @code{G1445@dots{}}
8e04817f 15426<- @code{+}
d2c6833e
AC
15427-> @code{s}
15428<- @code{+}
15429@emph{time passes}
15430<- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
8e04817f 15431-> @code{+}
d2c6833e 15432-> @code{g}
8e04817f 15433<- @code{+}
d2c6833e
AC
15434<- @code{1455@dots{}}
15435-> @code{+}
474c8240 15436@end smallexample
eb12ee30 15437
aab4e0ec 15438@include gpl.texi
eb12ee30 15439
6826cf00
EZ
15440@include fdl.texi
15441
6d2ebf8b 15442@node Index
c906108c
SS
15443@unnumbered Index
15444
15445@printindex cp
15446
15447@tex
15448% I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
15449% meantime:
15450\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
15451\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
15452\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
15453\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
15454\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
15455\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
15456\centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
15457\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
15458\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
15459\page\colophon
15460% Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
15461@end tex
15462
c906108c 15463@bye